blob: 78dfe23eae2b441ab5701535681bc32bf5d2bce5 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau0e658fb2016-11-25 16:55:50 +01005 version 1.8
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau7b677262017-04-03 09:27:49 +02007 2017/04/03
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200595. Bind and Server options
605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001069. Supported filters
1079.1. Trace
1089.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001099.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200110
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111
1121. Quick reminder about HTTP
113----------------------------
114
115When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
116fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
117on almost anything found in the contents.
118
119However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
120formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
121correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
122
123
1241.1. The HTTP transaction model
125-------------------------------
126
127The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100128to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
130connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
131will involve a new connection :
132
133 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
134
135In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
136establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
137by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
138length.
139
140Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
141to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
142however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
143response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
144header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
145
146 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
147
148Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
149power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
150but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200151a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152
153A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
154keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
155second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
156page :
157
158 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
159
160This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
161latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
162correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
163the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100164server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100166By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
167connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
168leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
169start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200170
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100171HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
172 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
173 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
174 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
175 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
176 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
177 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
178
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179
1801.2. HTTP request
181-----------------
182
183First, let's consider this HTTP request :
184
185 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100186 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200187 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
188 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
189 3 User-agent: my small browser
190 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
191 5 Accept: image/png
192
193
1941.2.1. The Request line
195-----------------------
196
197Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
198
199 - a METHOD : GET
200 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
201 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
202
203All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
204which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
205followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
206is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
207desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
208the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
209
210The URI itself can have several forms :
211
212 - A "relative URI" :
213
214 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
215
216 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
217 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
218
219 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
220
221 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
222
223 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
224 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
225 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
226 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
227 must accept this form too.
228
229 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
230 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
231 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100232
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200233 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
234 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
235 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
236 other protocols too.
237
238In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
239mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
240on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
241It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
242specific to the language, framework or application in use.
243
244
2451.2.2. The request headers
246--------------------------
247
248The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
249beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
250an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
251Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
252values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
253encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
254the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
255define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
256
257Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
258their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
259"Connection:" header).
260
261The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
262that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
263is one valid form of empty line.
264
265Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
266headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
267about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
268application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
269
270Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000271 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200272 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
273 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
274 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
275
276
2771.3. HTTP response
278------------------
279
280An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
281messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
282
283 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100284 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200285 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
286 2 Content-length: 350
287 3 Content-Type: text/html
288
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200289As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
290codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
291response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100292continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
293the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
294following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
295sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
296(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
297correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
298such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
299state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
300over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
301if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
302information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200303
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200304
3051.3.1. The Response line
306------------------------
307
308Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
309
310 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
311 - a status code : 200
312 - a reason : OK
313
314The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200315 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200316 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
317 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
318 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
319 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
320
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000321Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100322"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200323found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
324messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
325or "Authentication Required".
326
327Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
328
329 Code When / reason
330 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
331 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
332 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
333 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100334 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
335 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200336 400 for an invalid or too large request
337 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
338 accessing the stats page)
339 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
340 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
341 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
342 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
343 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
344 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
345 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
346 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
347 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
348
349The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3504.2).
351
352
3531.3.2. The response headers
354---------------------------
355
356Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
357the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
358details.
359
360
3612. Configuring HAProxy
362----------------------
363
3642.1. Configuration file format
365------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200366
367HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
368
369 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
370 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
371 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
372 "frontend" and "backend".
373
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100374The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
375referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200376delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100377
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200378
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02003792.2. Quoting and escaping
380-------------------------
381
382HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
383many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
384with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
385single quotes.
386
387If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
388them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
389escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
390
391Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
392
393 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
394 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
395 \\ to use a backslash
396 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
397 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
398
399Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
400the interpretation of:
401
402 space as a parameter separator
403 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
404 # hash as a comment start
405
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200406Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
407-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
408backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
409
410Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200411quoting.
412
413Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
414nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
415
416Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
417equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
418
419 Example:
420 # those are equivalents:
421 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
422 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
423 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
424 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
425 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
426
427 # those are equivalents:
428 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
429 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
430 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
431 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
432
433
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004342.3. Environment variables
435--------------------------
436
437HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
438interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
439configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
440optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
441shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
442underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
443
444 Example:
445
446 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
447
448 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
449
450 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
451
452
4532.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200454----------------
455
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100456Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100457values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
458otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
459numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
460for every keyword. Supported units are :
461
462 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
463 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
464 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
465 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
466 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
467 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
468
469
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00004702.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200471-------------
472
473 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
474 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
475 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
476 global
477 daemon
478 maxconn 256
479
480 defaults
481 mode http
482 timeout connect 5000ms
483 timeout client 50000ms
484 timeout server 50000ms
485
486 frontend http-in
487 bind *:80
488 default_backend servers
489
490 backend servers
491 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
492
493
494 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
495 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
496 global
497 daemon
498 maxconn 256
499
500 defaults
501 mode http
502 timeout connect 5000ms
503 timeout client 50000ms
504 timeout server 50000ms
505
506 listen http-in
507 bind *:80
508 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
509
510
511Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
512
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100513 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200514
515
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005163. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200517--------------------
518
519Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
520are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
521of them have command-line equivalents.
522
523The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
524
525 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200526 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200527 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200528 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200529 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200530 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200531 - description
532 - deviceatlas-json-file
533 - deviceatlas-log-level
534 - deviceatlas-separator
535 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900536 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200537 - gid
538 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100539 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200540 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200541 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100542 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200543 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200544 - nbproc
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200545 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200546 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100547 - presetenv
548 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200549 - uid
550 - ulimit-n
551 - user
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100552 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200553 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200554 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
555 - ssl-default-bind-options
556 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
557 - ssl-default-server-options
558 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100559 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100560 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100561 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100562 - 51degrees-data-file
563 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200564 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200565 - 51degrees-cache-size
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +0100566 - wurfl-data-file
567 - wurfl-information-list
568 - wurfl-information-list-separator
569 - wurfl-engine-mode
570 - wurfl-cache-size
571 - wurfl-useragent-priority
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100572
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200573 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200574 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200575 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200576 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100577 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100578 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100579 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200580 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200581 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200582 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200583 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200584 - noepoll
585 - nokqueue
586 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100587 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300588 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000589 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200590 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200591 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200592 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000593 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000594 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200595 - tune.buffers.limit
596 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200597 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200598 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100599 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100600 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200601 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200602 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100603 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100604 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100605 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100606 - tune.lua.session-timeout
607 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200608 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100609 - tune.maxaccept
610 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200611 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200612 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200613 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100614 - tune.rcvbuf.client
615 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100616 - tune.recv_enough
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100617 - tune.sndbuf.client
618 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100619 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100620 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200621 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100622 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200623 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200624 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100625 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200626 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100627 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200628 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
629 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
630 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100631 - tune.zlib.memlevel
632 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100633
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200634 * Debugging
635 - debug
636 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200637
638
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006393.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200640------------------------------------
641
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200642ca-base <dir>
643 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200644 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
645 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200646
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200647chroot <jail dir>
648 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
649 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
650 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
651 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
652 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
653 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100654
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100655cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
656 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
657 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
658 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100659 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
660 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
661 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
662 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
663 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
664 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
665 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
666 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
667 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
668 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100669
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200670crt-base <dir>
671 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
672 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
673 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
674
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200675daemon
676 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
677 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
678 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
679
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200680deviceatlas-json-file <path>
681 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
682 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by Haproxy process.
683
684deviceatlas-log-level <value>
685 Sets the level of informations returned by the API. This directive is
686 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
687
688deviceatlas-separator <char>
689 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
690 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
691
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100692deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200693 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
694 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
695 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100696
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900697external-check
698 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
699 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
700 See "option external-check".
701
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200702gid <number>
703 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
704 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
705 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100706 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
707 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200708 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100709
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100710hard-stop-after <time>
711 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
712
713 Arguments :
714 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
715 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
716 SIGUSR1 signal.
717
718 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
719 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
720 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
721
722 Example:
723 global
724 hard-stop-after 30s
725
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200726group <group name>
727 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
728 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100729
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200730log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200731 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
732 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100733 configured with "log global".
734
735 <address> can be one of:
736
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100737 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100738 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
739 port).
740
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100741 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
742 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
743 port).
744
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100745 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
746 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
747 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
748 writeable).
749
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200750 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
751 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100752
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200753 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
754 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
755 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
756 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
757 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
758 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
759 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
760 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
761 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
762 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200763 JSON-formated logs may require larger values. You may also need to
764 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request uris are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200765
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200766 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
767 one of the following :
768
769 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
770 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
771
772 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
773 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
774
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100775 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200776
777 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
778 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
779 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
780
781 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200782 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
783 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
784 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
785 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
786 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
787 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200788
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200789 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200790
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100791log-send-hostname [<string>]
792 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
793 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
794 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
795 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
796 the logs.
797
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000798log-tag <string>
799 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
800 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
801 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100802 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000803
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100804lua-load <file>
805 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
806 used multiple times.
807
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200808master-worker [exit-on-failure]
809 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
810 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
811 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
812 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
813 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
814 systemd.
815 The "exit-on-failure" option allows the master to kill every workers and
816 exit when one of the current workers died. It is convenient to combine this
817 option with Restart=on-failure in a systemd unit file in order to relaunch
818 the whole process.
819
820 See alors "-W" in the management guide.
821
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200822nbproc <number>
823 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
824 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
825 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
826 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
827 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
828
829pidfile <pidfile>
830 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
831 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
832 starting the process. See also "daemon".
833
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100834presetenv <name> <value>
835 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
836 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
837 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
838 and "unsetenv".
839
840resetenv [<name> ...]
841 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
842 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
843 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
844 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
845 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
846 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
847 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
848 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
849
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100850stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200851 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
852 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
853 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
854 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
855 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
856 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100857 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200858 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
859 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200860
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200861server-state-base <directory>
862 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200863 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
864 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200865
866server-state-file <file>
867 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
868 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
869 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
870 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
871 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
872 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
873 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
874 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200875 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
876 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200877
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100878setenv <name> <value>
879 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
880 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
881 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
882 and "unsetenv".
883
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100884ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
885 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
886 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300887 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100888 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
889 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
890 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
891 "bind" keyword for more information.
892
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100893ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
894 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
895 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
896 keyword to see available options.
897
898 Example:
899 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +0200900 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100901
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100902ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
903 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
904 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300905 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100906 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
907 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
908 information.
909
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100910ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
911 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
912 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
913 keyword to see available options.
914
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200915ssl-dh-param-file <file>
916 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
917 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
918 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
919 which do not explicitely define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
920 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200921 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
922 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
923 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
924 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200925 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
926 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
927 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
928
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100929ssl-server-verify [none|required]
930 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
931 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
932 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
933
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200934stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
935 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
936 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
937 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +0200938 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
939 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200940
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200941 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
942 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
943 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200944
945stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
946 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
947 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100948 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200949
950stats maxconn <connections>
951 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
952 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
953
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200954uid <number>
955 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
956 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
957 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
958 one. See also "gid" and "user".
959
960ulimit-n <number>
961 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
962 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
963 option.
964
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100965unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
966 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
967
968 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
969 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
970 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
971 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
972 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
973 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
974 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
975 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
976 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
977 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
978
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100979unsetenv [<name> ...]
980 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
981 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
982 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
983 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
984 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
985 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
986 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
987
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200988user <user name>
989 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
990 See also "uid" and "group".
991
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200992node <name>
993 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
994
995 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
996 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
997 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
998 traffic.
999
1000description <text>
1001 Add a text that describes the instance.
1002
1003 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1004 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1005 "<" and ">" characters.
1006
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100100751degrees-data-file <file path>
1008 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
1009 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevavnt permissions.
1010
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001011 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001012 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1013
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000101451degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001015 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1016 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1017 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1018
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001019 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001020 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1021
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200102251degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001023 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1024 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1025
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001026 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1027 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1028
102951degrees-cache-size <number>
1030 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1031 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1032 By default, this cache is disabled.
1033
1034 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001035 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1036
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001037wurfl-data-file <file path>
1038 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1039 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1040
1041 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1042 with USE_WURFL=1.
1043
1044wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1045 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1046 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1047 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1048
1049 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1050
1051 Valid WURFL properties are:
1052 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1053
1054 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1055 device.
1056
1057 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1058 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1059
1060 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1061 particular web request.
1062
1063 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1064 used Libwurfl API version.
1065
1066 - wurfl_engine_target Contains a string representing the currently
1067 set WURFL Engine Target. Possible values are
1068 "HIGH_ACCURACY", "HIGH_PERFORMANCE", "INVALID".
1069
1070 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1071 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1072
1073 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1074 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1075
1076 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1077
1078 - wurfl_useragent_priority The user agent priority used by WURFL.
1079
1080 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1081 with USE_WURFL=1.
1082
1083wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1084 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1085 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1086
1087 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1088 with USE_WURFL=1.
1089
1090wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1091 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1092 thus before the chroot.
1093
1094 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1095 with USE_WURFL=1.
1096
1097wurfl-engine-mode { accuracy | performance }
1098 Sets the WURFL engine target. You can choose between 'accuracy' or
1099 'performance' targets. In performance mode, desktop web browser detection is
1100 done programmatically without referencing the WURFL data. As a result, most
1101 desktop web browsers are returned as generic_web_browser WURFL ID for
1102 performance. If either performance or accuracy are not defined, performance
1103 mode is enabled by default.
1104
1105 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1106 with USE_WURFL=1.
1107
1108wurfl-cache-size <U>[,<D>]
1109 Sets the WURFL caching strategy. Here <U> is the Useragent cache size, and
1110 <D> is the internal device cache size. There are three possibilities here :
1111 - "0" : no cache is used.
1112 - <U> : the Single LRU cache is used, the size is expressed in elements.
1113 - <U>,<D> : the Double LRU cache is used, both sizes are in elements. This is
1114 the highest performing option.
1115
1116 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1117 with USE_WURFL=1.
1118
1119wurfl-useragent-priority { plain | sideloaded_browser }
1120 Tells WURFL if it should prioritize use of the plain user agent ('plain')
1121 over the default sideloaded browser user agent ('sideloaded_browser').
1122
1123 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1124 with USE_WURFL=1.
1125
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001126
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011273.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001128-----------------------
1129
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001130max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1131 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1132 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1133 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1134 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1135 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1136 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1137 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1138 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1139
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001140maxconn <number>
1141 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1142 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1143 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001144 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1145 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1146 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1147 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001148 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
1149 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
1150 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
1151 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
1152 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001153
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001154maxconnrate <number>
1155 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1156 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1157 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1158 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1159 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1160 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1161 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1162 fairness.
1163
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001164maxcomprate <number>
1165 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001166 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001167 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1168 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1169 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
1170 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
1171 default value.
1172
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001173maxcompcpuusage <number>
1174 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1175 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1176 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1177 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1178 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1179 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1180 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1181 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1182
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001183maxpipes <number>
1184 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1185 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1186 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1187 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1188 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1189 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1190
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001191maxsessrate <number>
1192 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1193 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1194 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1195 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1196 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1197 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1198 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1199 fairness.
1200
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001201maxsslconn <number>
1202 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1203 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1204 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1205 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1206 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1207 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1208 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001209 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1210 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1211 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1212 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1213 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1214 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1215 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001216
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001217maxsslrate <number>
1218 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1219 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1220 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1221 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1222 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1223 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1224 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1225 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1226 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1227 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1228
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001229maxzlibmem <number>
1230 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1231 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1232 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001233 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1234 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1235 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1236
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001237noepoll
1238 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1239 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001240 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001241
1242nokqueue
1243 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1244 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1245 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1246
1247nopoll
1248 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1249 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001250 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001251 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001252
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001253nosplice
1254 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
1255 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
1256 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001257 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001258 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1259 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1260 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1261 "option splice-response".
1262
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001263nogetaddrinfo
1264 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1265 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1266
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001267noreuseport
1268 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1269 command line argument "-dR".
1270
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001271spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001272 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1273 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1274 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1275 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1276 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1277 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001278
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001279ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-seperated list of algorithms>]
1280 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
1281 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
1282 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1283 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1284 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1285 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1286 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
1287 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1288 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-seperated list
1289 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1290 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1291 openssl configuration file uses:
1292 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1293
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001294ssl-mode-async
1295 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001296 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
1297 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines.
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001298
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001299tune.buffers.limit <number>
1300 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1301 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1302 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1303 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1304 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
1305 behaviour. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
1306 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1307 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1308 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1309 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1310 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1311 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1312 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1313 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1314 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1315
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001316tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1317 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1318 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1319 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1320 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1321
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001322tune.bufsize <number>
1323 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1324 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1325 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1326 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1327 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1328 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1329 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
1330 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001331 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
1332 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
1333 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001334
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001335tune.chksize <number>
1336 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1337 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1338 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1339 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1340 checks whenever possible.
1341
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001342tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1343 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1344 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1345 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1346 this value. The default value is 1.
1347
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001348tune.http.cookielen <number>
1349 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1350 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1351 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1352 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1353 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1354 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1355 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1356 to change this value.
1357
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001358tune.http.logurilen <number>
1359 Sets the maximum length of request uri in logs. This prevent to truncate long
1360 requests uris with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
1361 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
1362 'log ... len yyyy' parameter. Your syslog deamon may also need specific
1363 configuration directives too.
1364 The default value is 1024.
1365
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001366tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1367 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1368 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1369 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1370 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1371 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1372 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
1373 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
1374 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
1375 limit too high.
1376
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001377tune.idletimer <timeout>
1378 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1379 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1380 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1381 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1382 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1383 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
1384 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
1385 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1386 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1387
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001388tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1389 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001390 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001391 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1392 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
1393 executes some Lua code but more reactivity is required, this value can be
1394 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1395 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1396
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001397tune.lua.maxmem
1398 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1399 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1400 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1401 memory.
1402
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001403tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1404 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001405 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1406 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1407 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001408
1409tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1410 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1411 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1412 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1413 check servers.
1414
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001415tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1416 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1417 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1418 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1419 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
1420
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001421tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001422 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1423 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1424 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1425 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1426 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1427 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1428 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1429 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1430 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1431 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001432
1433tune.maxpollevents <number>
1434 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1435 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1436 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1437 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1438 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1439
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001440tune.maxrewrite <number>
1441 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1442 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1443 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1444 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1445 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1446 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1447 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1448 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1449 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1450 bufsize.
1451
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001452tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1453 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1454 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1455 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1456 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1457 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1458 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1459 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1460 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1461 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1462 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1463 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1464 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1465 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1466 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1467 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1468 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1469 setting this parameter to 0.
1470
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001471tune.pipesize <number>
1472 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1473 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1474 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1475 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1476 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1477 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1478
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001479tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1480tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1481 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1482 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1483 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1484 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1485 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1486 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1487 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1488
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001489tune.recv_enough <number>
1490 Haproxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
1491 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1492 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1493 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1494 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1495
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001496tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1497tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1498 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1499 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1500 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1501 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1502 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1503 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1504 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1505 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1506 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1507 notifying haproxy again.
1508
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001509tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001510 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1511 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1512 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001513 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001514 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1515 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1516 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1517 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1518 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001519 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1520 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001521
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001522tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1523 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1524 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1525 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1526 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1527 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1528 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1529
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001530tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1531 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001532 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001533 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1534 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1535 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1536 being used for too long.
1537
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001538tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1539 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1540 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1541 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1542 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1543 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1544 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1545 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1546 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1547 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1548 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001549 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1550 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001551
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001552tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1553 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1554 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1555 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1556 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1557 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1558 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1559 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001560 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1561 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001562
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001563tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1564 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1565 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1566 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1567 1000 entries.
1568
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001569tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1570 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1571 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1572 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1573
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001574tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001575tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001576tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1577tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1578tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001579 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1580 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1581 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1582 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1583 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1584 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1585 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1586 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001587
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001588 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1589 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1590 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1591 all available space is consumed.
1592 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1593 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1594 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001595
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001596tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1597 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001598 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001599 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1600 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1601 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1602
1603tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1604 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1605 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1606 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1607 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001608
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016093.3. Debugging
1610--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001611
1612debug
1613 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1614 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1615 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1616 system startup.
1617
1618quiet
1619 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1620 line argument "-q".
1621
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001622
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016233.4. Userlists
1624--------------
1625It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1626http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1627it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1628
1629userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001630 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001631 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1632
1633group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001634 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001635 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1636 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1637
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001638user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1639 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001640 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1641 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001642 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1643 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001644 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001645 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001646
1647
1648 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001649 userlist L1
1650 group G1 users tiger,scott
1651 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001652
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001653 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1654 user scott insecure-password elgato
1655 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001656
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001657 userlist L2
1658 group G1
1659 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001660
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001661 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1662 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1663 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001664
1665 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001666
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001667
16683.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001669----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001670It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1671several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1672instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1673values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1674automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1675In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1676using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1677tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1678reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1679Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1680that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1681each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001682
1683peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001684 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001685 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1686
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001687disabled
1688 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1689 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1690 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1691
1692enable
1693 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1694
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001695peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1696 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1697 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1698 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1699 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1700 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1701 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1702
1703 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1704 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1705
1706 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1707 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1708 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1709 across all peers.
1710
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001711 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1712 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001713
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001714 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001715 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001716 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1717 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1718 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001719
1720 backend mybackend
1721 mode tcp
1722 balance roundrobin
1723 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1724 stick on src
1725
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001726 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1727 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001728
1729
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090017303.6. Mailers
1731------------
1732It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1733If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1734in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1735
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02001736mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001737 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1738 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1739
1740mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1741 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1742
1743 Example:
1744 mailers mymailers
1745 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1746 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1747
1748 backend mybackend
1749 mode tcp
1750 balance roundrobin
1751
1752 email-alert mailers mymailers
1753 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1754 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1755
1756 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1757 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1758
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01001759timeout mail <time>
1760 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
1761 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
1762 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
1763 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
1764
1765 Example:
1766 mailers mymailers
1767 timeout mail 20s
1768 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001769
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017704. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001771----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001772
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001773Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02001774 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001775 - frontend <name>
1776 - backend <name>
1777 - listen <name>
1778
1779A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1780its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1781section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001782section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001783
1784A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1785connections.
1786
1787A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1788to forward incoming connections.
1789
1790A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1791parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1792
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001793All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1794'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1795case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1796
1797Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1798logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1799proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1800However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1801name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1802
1803Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1804and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001805bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001806protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1807modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1808arbitrary criteria.
1809
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001810In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1811a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1812the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1813
1814 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1815 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1816 between responses and new requests.
1817
1818 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1819 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1820 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1821 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1822
1823 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1824 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1825 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1826
1827 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1828 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1829 client-facing connection remains open.
1830
1831 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1832 after the end of the response.
1833
1834The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1835frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1836following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1837weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1838
1839 Backend mode
1840
1841 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1842 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1843 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1844 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1845 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1846 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1847 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1848 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1849 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1850 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1851 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1852
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001853
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001854
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018554.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1856--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001857
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001858The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1859limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1860they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1861limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001862marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001863option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001864and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1865with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1866specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001867
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001868
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001869 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1870------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1871acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02001872appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001873backlog X X X -
1874balance X - X X
1875bind - X X -
1876bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02001877block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001878capture cookie - X X -
1879capture request header - X X -
1880capture response header - X X -
1881clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001882compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001883contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1884cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02001885declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001886default-server X - X X
1887default_backend X X X -
1888description - X X X
1889disabled X X X X
1890dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001891email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09001892email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001893email-alert mailers X X X X
1894email-alert myhostname X X X X
1895email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001896enabled X X X X
1897errorfile X X X X
1898errorloc X X X X
1899errorloc302 X X X X
1900-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1901errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001902force-persist - X X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001903filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001904fullconn X - X X
1905grace X X X X
1906hash-type X - X X
1907http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001908http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001909http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001910http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001911http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02001912http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001913http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001914id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001915ignore-persist - X X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001916load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001917log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001918log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001919log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001920log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001921max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001922maxconn X X X -
1923mode X X X X
1924monitor fail - X X -
1925monitor-net X X X -
1926monitor-uri X X X -
1927option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1928option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1929option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1930option allbackups (*) X - X X
1931option checkcache (*) X - X X
1932option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1933option contstats (*) X X X -
1934option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1935option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1936option forceclose (*) X X X X
1937-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1938option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02001939option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02001940option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001941option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001942option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001943option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001944option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001945option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001946option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1947option httpchk X - X X
1948option httpclose (*) X X X X
1949option httplog X X X X
1950option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001951option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001952option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001953option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001954option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1955option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1956option logasap (*) X X X -
1957option mysql-check X - X X
1958option nolinger (*) X X X X
1959option originalto X X X X
1960option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02001961option pgsql-check X - X X
1962option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001963option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001964option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001965option smtpchk X - X X
1966option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1967option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1968option splice-request (*) X X X X
1969option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01001970option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001971option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1972option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1973-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001974option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001975option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1976option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1977option tcpka X X X X
1978option tcplog X X X X
1979option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001980external-check command X - X X
1981external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001982persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1983rate-limit sessions X X X -
1984redirect - X X X
1985redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1986redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1987reqadd - X X X
1988reqallow - X X X
1989reqdel - X X X
1990reqdeny - X X X
1991reqiallow - X X X
1992reqidel - X X X
1993reqideny - X X X
1994reqipass - X X X
1995reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001996reqitarpit - X X X
1997reqpass - X X X
1998reqrep - X X X
1999-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002000reqtarpit - X X X
2001retries X - X X
2002rspadd - X X X
2003rspdel - X X X
2004rspdeny - X X X
2005rspidel - X X X
2006rspideny - X X X
2007rspirep - X X X
2008rsprep - X X X
2009server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002010server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002011server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002012source X - X X
2013srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002014stats admin - X X X
2015stats auth X X X X
2016stats enable X X X X
2017stats hide-version X X X X
2018stats http-request - X X X
2019stats realm X X X X
2020stats refresh X X X X
2021stats scope X X X X
2022stats show-desc X X X X
2023stats show-legends X X X X
2024stats show-node X X X X
2025stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002026-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2027stick match - - X X
2028stick on - - X X
2029stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002030stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002031stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002032tcp-check connect - - X X
2033tcp-check expect - - X X
2034tcp-check send - - X X
2035tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002036tcp-request connection - X X -
2037tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002038tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002039tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002040tcp-response content - - X X
2041tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002042timeout check X - X X
2043timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002044timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002045timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
2046timeout connect X - X X
2047timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2048timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2049timeout http-request X X X X
2050timeout queue X - X X
2051timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002052timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002053timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2054timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002055timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002056transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002057unique-id-format X X X -
2058unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002059use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002060use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002061------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2062 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002063
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002064
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020654.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2066---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002067
2068This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2069
2070
2071acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2072 Declare or complete an access list.
2073 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2074 no | yes | yes | yes
2075 Example:
2076 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2077 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2078 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2079
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002080 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002081
2082
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002083appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
2084 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002085 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
2086 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2087 no | no | yes | yes
2088 Arguments :
2089 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
2090 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
2091
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002092 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002093 checked in each cookie value.
2094
2095 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
2096 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
2097 milliseconds.
2098
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02002099 request-learn
2100 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
2101 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
2102 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
2103 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
2104 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
2105 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
2106
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002107 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
2108 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
2109 data following this prefix.
2110
2111 Example :
2112 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
2113
2114 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
2115 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
2116
2117 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
2118 2 modes are currently supported :
2119 - path-parameters :
2120 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
2121 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
2122 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
2123 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
2124 - query-string :
2125 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
2126 query string.
2127
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002128 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
2129 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
2130 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002131
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01002132 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
2133 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002134
2135
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002136backlog <conns>
2137 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2138 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2139 yes | yes | yes | no
2140 Arguments :
2141 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2142 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002143 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002144
2145 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2146 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2147 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2148 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2149 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2150 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2151 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2152 backlog parameter.
2153
2154 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2155 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2156 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2157
2158 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2159
2160
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002161balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002162balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002163 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2164 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2165 yes | no | yes | yes
2166 Arguments :
2167 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2168 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2169 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2170 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2171
2172 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2173 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2174 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2175 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002176 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002177 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002178 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2179 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2180 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2181 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2182 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2183 it, so that you don't worry.
2184
2185 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2186 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2187 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2188 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2189 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2190 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2191 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2192 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002193
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002194 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2195 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2196 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2197 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2198 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2199 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2200 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2201 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2202
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002203 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002204 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002205 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2206 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002207 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002208 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2209 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2210 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2211 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2212 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002213 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2214 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2215 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2216 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2217 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2218 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002219
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002220 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2221 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2222 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2223 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2224 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2225 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2226 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2227 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002228 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002229 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002230 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2231 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2232 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002233
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002234 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2235 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2236 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2237 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2238 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2239 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2240 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2241 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2242 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2243 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2244 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2245 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002246
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002247 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002248 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2249 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2250 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2251 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2252 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2253 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2254 URIs start with a leading "/".
2255
2256 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2257 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2258 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2259 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2260
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002261 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002262 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2263
2264 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002265 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2266 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002267 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2268 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2269 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2270 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002271 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002272 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2273 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002274
2275 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2276 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2277 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2278 server will receive the request.
2279
2280 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2281 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2282 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2283 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2284 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002285 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2286 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2287 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002288
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002289 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2290 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2291 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2292 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2293 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002294
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002295 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002296 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2297 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2298 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2299
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002300 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2301 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2302 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2303
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002304 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002305 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002306 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2307 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2308 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2309 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2310 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2311 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002312 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002313 used instead.
2314
2315 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2316 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2317 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2318 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2319
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002320 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2321 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2322 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2323
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002324 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002325
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002326 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002327 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2328 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002329
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002330 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2331 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2332 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002333
2334 Examples :
2335 balance roundrobin
2336 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002337 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002338 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2339 balance hdr(host)
2340 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002341
2342 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2343 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2344
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002345 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002346 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2347 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2348 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2349 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2350
2351 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2352 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2353 defaults to 16 kB.
2354
2355 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2356 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2357
2358 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2359 Round Robin.
2360
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002361 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002362 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2363 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2364 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2365
2366 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2367
2368 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002369 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002370 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2371 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2372 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002373
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002374 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002375
2376
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002377bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2378bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002379 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2380 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2381 no | yes | yes | no
2382 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002383 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2384 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2385 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2386 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002387 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002388 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2389 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2390 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2391 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2392 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2393 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2394 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002395 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2396 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2397 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2398 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2399 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2400 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2401 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002402 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2403 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2404 be listening.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002405 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2406 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2407 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002408
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002409 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2410 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002411 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2412 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2413 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002414 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2415 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2416 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2417 the range.
2418
2419 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2420 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2421 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2422 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2423 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2424 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2425 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002426 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002427 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002428
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002429 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
2430 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
2431 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2432 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2433 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2434 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2435 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2436 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2437
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002438 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2439 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2440 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2441 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002442
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002443 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2444 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2445 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2446 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2447 in a frontend.
2448
2449 Example :
2450 listen http_proxy
2451 bind :80,:443
2452 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002453 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002454
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002455 listen http_https_proxy
2456 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002457 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002458
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002459 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2460 bind ipv6@:80
2461 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2462 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2463
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002464 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002465 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002466
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002467 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2468 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2469 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2470 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2471 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2472
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002473 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002474 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002475
2476
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002477bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002478 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2479 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2480 yes | yes | yes | yes
2481 Arguments :
2482 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2483 may be used to override a default value.
2484
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002485 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002486 option may be combined with other numbers.
2487
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002488 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002489 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2490 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2491 missing from all processes.
2492
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002493 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002494 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002495 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
2496 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
2497 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
2498 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002499
2500 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2501 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2502 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2503 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2504 and 'even' instances.
2505
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002506 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2507 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2508 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2509 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002510
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002511 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2512 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2513
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002514 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2515 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2516 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2517
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002518 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2519 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2520
2521 Example :
2522 listen app_ip1
2523 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002524 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002525
2526 listen app_ip2
2527 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002528 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002529
2530 listen management
2531 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002532 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002533
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002534 listen management
2535 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2536 bind-process 1-4
2537
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002538 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002539
2540
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002541block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002542 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2543 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2544 no | yes | yes | yes
2545
2546 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2547 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002548 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002549 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002550 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002551 "block" statements per instance. To block connections at layer 4 (without
2552 sending a 403 error) see "tcp-request connection reject" and
2553 "tcp-request content reject" rules.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002554
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002555 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
2556 "http-request deny" instead.
2557
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002558 Example:
2559 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2560 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2561 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +03002562 # block is deprecated. Use http-request deny instead:
2563 #block if invalid_src || local_dst
2564 http-request deny if invalid_src || local_dst
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002565
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002566 See also : section 7 about ACL usage, "http-request deny",
2567 "http-response deny", "tcp-request connection reject" and
2568 "tcp-request content reject".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002569
2570capture cookie <name> len <length>
2571 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2572 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2573 no | yes | yes | no
2574 Arguments :
2575 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2576 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2577 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2578 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
2579 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
2580
2581 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2582 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2583 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2584 right if it exceeds <length>.
2585
2586 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2587 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2588 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2589 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2590
2591 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2592 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2593 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2594
2595 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2596 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2597 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002598 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2599 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2600 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002601
2602 Example:
2603 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2604
2605 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002606 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002607
2608
2609capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002610 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002611 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2612 no | yes | yes | no
2613 Arguments :
2614 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002615 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002616 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2617 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2618 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2619
2620 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2621 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2622 it exceeds <length>.
2623
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002624 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002625 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2626 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002627 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2628 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2629 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2630 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002631 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002632 environments to find where the request came from.
2633
2634 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2635 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2636 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2637 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002638
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002639 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2640 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2641 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2642 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2643 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002644
2645 Example:
2646 capture request header Host len 15
2647 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01002648 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002649
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002650 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002651 about logging.
2652
2653
2654capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002655 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002656 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2657 no | yes | yes | no
2658 Arguments :
2659 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002660 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002661 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2662 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2663 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2664
2665 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2666 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2667 it exceeds <length>.
2668
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002669 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002670 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2671 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2672 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002673 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2674 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2675 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2676 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002677
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002678 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2679 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2680 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2681 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2682 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002683
2684 Example:
2685 capture response header Content-length len 9
2686 capture response header Location len 15
2687
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002688 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002689 about logging.
2690
2691
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002692clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002693 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2694 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2695 yes | yes | yes | no
2696 Arguments :
2697 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2698 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2699 as explained at the top of this document.
2700
2701 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2702 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2703 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2704 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2705 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2706 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2707 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2708 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002709 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002710 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2711 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2712
2713 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2714 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2715 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2716 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2717 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2718 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2719
2720 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2721 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2722
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002723 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2724 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002725
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002726compression algo <algorithm> ...
2727compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002728compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002729 Enable HTTP compression.
2730 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2731 yes | yes | yes | yes
2732 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002733 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2734 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2735 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2736
2737 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002738 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
2739 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2740 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002741
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002742 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002743 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002744
2745 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2746 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
2747 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
2748 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
2749 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002750 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002751
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002752 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
2753 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
2754 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
2755 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
2756 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
2757 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
2758 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002759 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002760
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002761 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002762 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002763 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2764 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2765 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2766 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2767 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002768
2769 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2770 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2771 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2772 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2773 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002774 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2775 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2776 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2777 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2778 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002779 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2780 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002781
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002782 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002783 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2784 "Accept-Encoding" header
2785 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002786 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002787 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2788 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002789 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2790 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2791 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2792 "multipart"
2793 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2794 header
2795 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2796 and later
2797 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2798 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002799
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002800 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2801 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002802
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002803 Examples :
2804 compression algo gzip
2805 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002806
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002807
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002808contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002809 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2810 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2811 yes | no | yes | yes
2812 Arguments :
2813 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2814 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2815 as explained at the top of this document.
2816
2817 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002818 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002819 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002820 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2821 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2822 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2823 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2824
2825 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2826 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2827 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2828 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2829 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2830 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2831
2832 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2833 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2834 instead.
2835
2836 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2837 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2838
2839
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002840cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002841 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2842 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01002843 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002844 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2845 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2846 yes | no | yes | yes
2847 Arguments :
2848 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2849 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2850 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2851 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2852 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2853 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2854 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2855 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2856 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2857
2858 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2859 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2860 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2861 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2862 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2863 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002864 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
2865 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
2866 behaviour is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
2867 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
2868 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002869
2870 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002871 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002872
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002873 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002874 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2875 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2876 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2877 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2878 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2879 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2880 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2881 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2882 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2883 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002884
2885 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2886 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2887 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2888 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2889 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2890 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2891 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2892 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2893 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002894 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002895 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2896 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2897 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002898
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002899 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2900 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2901 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002902 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2903 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2904 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2905 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002906 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2907 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2908 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002909
2910 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2911 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2912 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2913 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2914 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2915 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2916 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2917 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2918 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2919
2920 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2921 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2922 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2923 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2924 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2925 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2926 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2927 persistence cookie in the cache.
2928 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2929
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002930 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2931 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2932 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2933 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2934 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2935 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2936 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2937 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2938 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2939 they logout.
2940
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002941 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2942 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2943 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2944 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2945
2946 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2947 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2948 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2949 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2950 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2951 this attribute.
2952
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002953 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002954 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002955 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2956 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2957 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2958 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2959 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2960 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002961
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002962 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2963 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2964 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2965 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2966 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2967 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2968 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2969 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2970 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2971 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2972 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2973 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2974 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2975 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2976 the site.
2977
2978 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2979 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2980 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2981 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2982 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2983 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2984 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2985 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2986 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2987 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2988 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2989 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2990 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2991 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2992 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2993 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2994
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01002995 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
2996 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
2997 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
2998 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
2999 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
3000 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
3001
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003002 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
3003 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
3004 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
3005 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003006
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003007 Examples :
3008 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
3009 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3010 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003011 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003012
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003013 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003014
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003015
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003016declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3017 Declares a capture slot.
3018 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3019 no | yes | yes | no
3020 Arguments:
3021 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3022
3023 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3024 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3025 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3026 for use in the response.
3027
3028 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003029 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003030 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3031
3032
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003033default-server [param*]
3034 Change default options for a server in a backend
3035 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3036 yes | no | yes | yes
3037 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003038 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3039 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3040 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3041 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003042
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003043 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003044 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3045
3046 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003047
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003048
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003049default_backend <backend>
3050 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3051 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3052 yes | yes | yes | no
3053 Arguments :
3054 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3055
3056 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3057 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3058 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3059 will catch all undetermined requests.
3060
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003061 Example :
3062
3063 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3064 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3065 default_backend dynamic
3066
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003067 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003068
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003069
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003070description <string>
3071 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3072 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3073 no | yes | yes | yes
3074 Arguments : string
3075
3076 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3077 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3078 it describes.
3079 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3080
3081
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003082disabled
3083 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3084 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3085 yes | yes | yes | yes
3086 Arguments : none
3087
3088 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3089 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3090 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3091 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3092 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3093 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3094 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3095
3096 See also : "enabled"
3097
3098
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003099dispatch <address>:<port>
3100 Set a default server address
3101 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3102 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003103 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003104
3105 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3106 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3107 during start-up.
3108
3109 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3110 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3111 possible with normal servers.
3112
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003113 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003114 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3115 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3116 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3117 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3118
3119 See also : "server"
3120
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003121
3122dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3123 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3124 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3125 yes | no | yes | yes
3126 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3127
3128 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
3129 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitely
3130 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3131 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
3132 That way, we can ensure session persistence accross multiple load-balancers,
3133 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003134
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003135enabled
3136 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3137 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3138 yes | yes | yes | yes
3139 Arguments : none
3140
3141 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3142 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3143
3144 See also : "disabled"
3145
3146
3147errorfile <code> <file>
3148 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3149 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3150 yes | yes | yes | yes
3151 Arguments :
3152 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
CJ Ess108b1dd2015-04-07 12:03:37 -04003153 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
3154 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003155
3156 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003157 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003158 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003159 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3160 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003161
3162 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3163 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3164 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3165
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003166 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3167
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003168 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3169 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3170 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3171 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3172
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003173 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3174 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
3175 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
3176 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3177 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3178 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3179
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003180 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3181 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3182 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003183 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003184 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3185
3186 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3187
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003188 Example :
3189 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003190 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003191 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3192 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3193
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003194
3195errorloc <code> <url>
3196errorloc302 <code> <url>
3197 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3198 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3199 yes | yes | yes | yes
3200 Arguments :
3201 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Jarno Huuskonen013a84f2017-04-22 11:26:50 +03003202 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
3203 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003204
3205 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3206 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3207 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3208 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3209 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3210
3211 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3212 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3213 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3214
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003215 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3216
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003217 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3218 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3219 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3220 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003221 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003222 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3223 request.
3224
3225 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3226
3227
3228errorloc303 <code> <url>
3229 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3230 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3231 yes | yes | yes | yes
3232 Arguments :
3233 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Jarno Huuskonen013a84f2017-04-22 11:26:50 +03003234 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
3235 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003236
3237 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3238 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3239 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3240 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3241 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3242
3243 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3244 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3245 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3246
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003247 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3248
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003249 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3250 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3251 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3252 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003253 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003254
3255 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3256
3257
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003258email-alert from <emailaddr>
3259 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
3260 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
3261 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3262 yes | yes | yes | yes
3263
3264 Arguments :
3265
3266 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3267
3268 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3269 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3270
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003271 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003272 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3273 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003274
3275
3276email-alert level <level>
3277 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3278 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3279 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3280 yes | yes | yes | yes
3281
3282 Arguments :
3283
3284 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3285 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3286 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3287
3288 By default level is alert
3289
3290 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3291 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3292 for the proxy.
3293
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003294 Alerts are sent when :
3295
3296 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3297 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3298 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3299 is notice or lower
3300 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3301 and a health check status update occurs
3302
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003303 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3304 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003305 section 3.6 about mailers.
3306
3307
3308email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3309 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3310 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3311 yes | yes | yes | yes
3312
3313 Arguments :
3314
3315 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3316
3317 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3318 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3319
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003320 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3321 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003322
3323
3324email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3325 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3326 mailers.
3327 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3328 yes | yes | yes | yes
3329
3330 Arguments :
3331
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003332 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003333
3334 By default the systems hostname is used.
3335
3336 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3337 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3338 for the proxy.
3339
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003340 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3341 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003342
3343
3344email-alert to <emailaddr>
3345 Declare both the recipent address in the envelope and to address in the
3346 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3347 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3348 yes | yes | yes | yes
3349
3350 Arguments :
3351
3352 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3353
3354 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3355 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3356
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003357 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003358 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3359
3360
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003361force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3362 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3363 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3364 no | yes | yes | yes
3365
3366 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3367 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3368 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3369 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3370 marked down for maintenance operations.
3371
3372 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3373 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3374 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3375 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3376 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3377 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3378 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3379 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3380 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3381
3382 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3383 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3384 is used.
3385
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003386 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003387 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003388
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003389
3390filter <name> [param*]
3391 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3392 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3393 no | yes | yes | yes
3394 Arguments :
3395 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3396 referenced in section 9.
3397
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003398 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003399 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003400 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3401 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003402
3403 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3404 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3405
3406 Example:
3407 listen
3408 bind *:80
3409
3410 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3411 filter compression
3412 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3413
3414 compression algo gzip
3415 compression offload
3416
3417 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3418
3419 See also : section 9.
3420
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003421
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003422fullconn <conns>
3423 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3424 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3425 yes | no | yes | yes
3426 Arguments :
3427 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3428 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3429
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003430 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003431 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003432 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003433 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3434 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3435 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3436 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3437 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003438 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003439
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003440 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3441 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003442 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3443 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3444 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003445
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003446 Example :
3447 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3448 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3449 # connections.
3450 backend dynamic
3451 fullconn 10000
3452 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3453 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3454
3455 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3456
3457
3458grace <time>
3459 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3460 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003461 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003462 Arguments :
3463 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3464 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3465 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3466
3467 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3468 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003469 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003470 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3471
3472 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3473 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3474 simplify it.
3475
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003476
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003477hash-balance-factor <factor>
3478 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3479 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3480 yes | no | no | yes
3481 Arguments :
3482 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3483 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
3484 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
3485
3486 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3487 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3488 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3489 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3490 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3491 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3492 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3493
3494 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3495 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3496 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3497 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3498 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3499
3500 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3501
3502
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003503hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003504 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3505 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3506 yes | no | yes | yes
3507 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003508 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3509 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003510
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003511 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3512 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3513 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3514 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3515 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3516 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3517 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3518 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3519 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3520 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003521
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003522 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3523 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3524 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3525 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3526 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3527 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3528 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3529 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3530 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3531 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3532 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3533 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3534 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003535 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3536 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003537
3538 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3539
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003540 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003541 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3542 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3543 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003544 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3545 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3546 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003547
3548 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3549 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003550 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3551 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3552 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3553 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3554
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003555 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3556 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3557 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3558 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3559 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3560 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3561 parameter.
3562
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003563 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3564 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3565 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3566 used on strings.
3567
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003568 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3569
3570 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3571 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3572 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3573 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3574 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3575 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3576 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3577 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3578 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3579 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3580 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3581 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003582
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003583 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3584 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3585 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003586
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003587 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003588
3589
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003590http-check disable-on-404
3591 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3592 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003593 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003594 Arguments : none
3595
3596 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3597 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3598 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3599 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3600 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3601 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3602 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3603 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003604 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3605 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3606 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3607
3608 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3609
3610
3611http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003612 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003613 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003614 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003615 Arguments :
3616 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3617 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003618 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003619 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3620 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3621 details on the supported keywords.
3622
3623 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3624 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3625 with the usual backslash ('\').
3626
3627 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3628 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3629 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3630 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3631 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3632
3633 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003634 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003635 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3636 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3637 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3638
3639 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003640 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003641 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3642 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3643 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3644 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3645
3646 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003647 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003648 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3649 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3650 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3651 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3652 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
3653 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
3654 trace).
3655
3656 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003657 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003658 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3659 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3660 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3661 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3662 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
3663 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
3664
3665 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3666 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3667 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3668 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3669 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3670 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3671 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3672 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3673
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003674 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3675 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3676 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3677
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003678 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3679 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3680
3681 Examples :
3682 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003683 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003684
3685 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003686 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003687
3688 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003689 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003690
3691 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03003692 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003693
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003694 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003695
3696
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003697http-check send-state
3698 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3699 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3700 yes | no | yes | yes
3701 Arguments : none
3702
3703 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3704 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3705 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3706 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3707 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3708
3709 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3710 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3711 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3712 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3713 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003714 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3715 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3716 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3717
3718 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3719 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3720 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3721
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003722 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3723 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3724 checked in multiple backends.
3725
3726 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3727 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3728
3729 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3730 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3731 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3732 one fails.
3733
3734 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3735 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3736 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3737
3738 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3739 server's queue.
3740
3741 Example of a header received by the application server :
3742 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3743 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3744
3745 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3746
Jarno Huuskonen800d1762017-03-06 14:56:36 +02003747http-request { allow | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
3748 tarpit [deny_status <status>] | deny [deny_status <status>] |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003749 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003750 capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003751 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003752 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
3753 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003754 set-method <fmt> | set-path <fmt> | set-query <fmt> |
3755 set-uri <fmt> | set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003756 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3757 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3758 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02003759 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003760 set-var(<var name>) <expr> |
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01003761 unset-var(<var name>) |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003762 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003763 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003764 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003765 silent-drop |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003766 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003767 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003768 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3769
3770 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3771 no | yes | yes | yes
3772
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003773 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3774 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3775 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3776 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3777 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003778
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003779 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3780 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
3781 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
3782
3783 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
Willy Tarreaube1d34d2016-06-26 19:37:59 +02003784 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code
3785 specified as an argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status
3786 codes is limited to those that can be overridden by the "errorfile"
3787 directive. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003788
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003789 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3790 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3791 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
Jarno Huuskonen800d1762017-03-06 14:56:36 +02003792 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status
3793 code specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003794 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3795 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3796 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3797 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3798 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003799 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003800 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. See
3801 also the "silent-drop" action below.
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003802
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003803 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
3804 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
3805 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
3806 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3807 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3808
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003809 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3810 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3811 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003812 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3813 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003814
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003815 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3816 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3817 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
3818 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
3819 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3820 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3821 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3822 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3823
3824 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3825 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3826 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01003827 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3828 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003829
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003830 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3831 <name>.
3832
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003833 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3834 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3835 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3836 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3837 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3838 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3839 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3840 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3841
3842 Example:
3843
3844 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3845
3846 applied to:
3847
3848 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3849
3850 outputs:
3851
3852 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3853
3854 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3855
3856 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3857 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3858 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3859 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3860 header.
3861
3862 Example:
3863
3864 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3865
3866 applied to:
3867
3868 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3869
3870 outputs:
3871
3872 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3873
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003874 - "set-method" rewrites the request method with the result of the
3875 evaluation of format string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons
3876 for having to do so as this is more likely to break something than to fix
3877 it.
3878
3879 - "set-path" rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of
3880 format string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a
3881 scheme and authority is found before the path, they are left intact as
3882 well. If the request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with
3883 the format. This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of
3884 a path for example. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3885
3886 Example :
3887 # prepend the host name before the path
3888 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
3889
3890 - "set-query" rewrites the request's query string which appears after the
3891 first question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format
3892 string <fmt>. The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the
3893 request doesn't contain a question mark and the new value is not empty,
3894 then one is added at the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If
3895 a question mark was present, it will never be removed even if the value
3896 is empty. This can be used to add or remove parameters from the query
3897 string. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3898
3899 Example :
3900 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
3901 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
3902
3903 - "set-uri" rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of
3904 format string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all
3905 replaced at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies,
3906 or to perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts
3907 between the path and the query string. See also "set-path" and
3908 "set-query".
3909
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003910 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3911 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3912 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3913 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3914 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3915 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3916 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3917 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3918
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003919 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3920 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3921 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3922 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3923 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3924 another equipment.
3925
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003926 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3927 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3928 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3929 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3930 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3931 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3932 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3933 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3934
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003935 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3936 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3937 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3938 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3939 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3940 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3941 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3942 admin privileges.
3943
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003944 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3945 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3946 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3947 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3948 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3949 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3950 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3951 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3952
3953 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3954 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3955 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3956 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3957 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3958 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3959
3960 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3961 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3962 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3963 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3964 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3965 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3966
3967 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3968 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3969 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3970 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3971 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3972 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3973 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3974 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3975 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3976
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003977 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] :
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02003978 captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts
3979 it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
3980 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear
3981 next to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in
3982 the logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules
3983 to feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
3984 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
3985 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
3986 request header" for more information.
3987
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003988 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store
3989 the captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful
3990 to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous
3991 directive "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01003992 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
3993 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003994
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02003995 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
3996 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
3997 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
3998 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
3999 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
4000 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
4001 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
4002 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
4003 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
4004 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
4005 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
4006 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
4007
4008 These actions take one or two arguments :
4009 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
4010 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
4011 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
4012 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
4013
4014 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
4015 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
4016 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
4017 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
4018
4019 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
4020 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
4021 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
4022 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
4023 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
4024 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
4025 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
4026 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
4027
4028 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
4029 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
4030 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
4031 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
4032 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
4033
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004034 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
4035 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
4036 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
4037 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
4038 continues.
4039
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004040 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
4041 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
4042 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4043 the actions evaluation continues.
4044
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004045 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr> :
4046 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4047 inline.
4048
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004049 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
4050 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01004051 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004052 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4053 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004054 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004055 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004056 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004057 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4058 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004059 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004060 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004061 and '_'.
4062
4063 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4064 followed by some converters.
4065
4066 Example:
4067
4068 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
4069
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004070 - unset-var(<var-name>) :
4071 Is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
4072
4073 Example:
4074
4075 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
4076
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004077 - set-src <expr> :
4078 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4079 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP,
4080 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
4081 source IP for privacy.
4082
4083 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4084 followed by some converters.
4085
4086 Example:
4087
4088 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4089 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4090
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004091 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4092 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004093
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004094 - set-src-port <expr> :
4095 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4096 expression.
4097
4098 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4099 followed by some converters.
4100
4101 Example:
4102
4103 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4104 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4105
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004106 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
4107 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
4108 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004109
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004110 - set-dst <expr> :
4111 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4112 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination
4113 IP, but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
4114 the IP for privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
4115 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
4116
4117 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4118 followed by some converters.
4119
4120 Example:
4121
4122 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4123 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
4124
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004125 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
4126 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
4127
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004128 - set-dst-port <expr> :
4129 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4130 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
4131 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
4132
4133 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4134 followed by some converters.
4135
4136 Example:
4137
4138 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4139 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
4140
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004141 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4142 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4143 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4144
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004145 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4146 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4147 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4148 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4149 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4150 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4151 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4152 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4153 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4154 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4155 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4156 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4157 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4158 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4159 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4160 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4161
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004162 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
4163
4164 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4165 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004166 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4167 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
4168
4169 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4170 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4171 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4172 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004173
4174 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004175 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4176 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4177 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004178
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004179 http-request allow if nagios
4180 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4181 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4182 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004183
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004184 Example:
4185 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004186 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004187
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004188 Example:
4189 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4190 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
Willy Tarreaufca42612015-08-27 17:15:05 +02004191 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004192 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4193 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4194 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4195 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4196 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4197 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
4198
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004199 Example:
4200 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4201 acl add path /addacl
4202 acl del path /delacl
4203
4204 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4205
4206 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4207 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
4208
4209 Example:
4210 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4211 acl setmap path /setmap
4212 acl delmap path /delmap
4213
4214 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4215
4216 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4217 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
4218
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02004219 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4220 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004221
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004222http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004223 capture <sample> id <id> | redirect <rule> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004224 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004225 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
4226 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004227 set-status <status> [reason <str>] |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004228 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
4229 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4230 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4231 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01004232 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004233 set-var(<var-name>) <expr> |
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004234 unset-var(<var-name>) |
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004235 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004236 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004237 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004238 silent-drop |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004239 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02004240 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004241 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4242
4243 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4244 no | yes | yes | yes
4245
4246 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4247 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4248 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4249 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4250 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4251 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4252
4253 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
4254 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
4255 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
4256 current section.
4257
4258 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
4259 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
4260 rules are evaluated.
4261
4262 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4263 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
4264 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
4265 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
4266 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4267 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
4268 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
4269
4270 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
4271 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4272 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4273 external users.
4274
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004275 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
4276 <name>.
4277
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004278 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
4279 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
4280 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
4281 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
4282 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4283 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
4284 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
4285 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
4286
4287 Example:
4288
4289 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4290
4291 applied to:
4292
4293 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4294
4295 outputs:
4296
4297 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4298
4299 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4300
4301 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
4302 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
4303 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
4304 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
4305 header.
4306
4307 Example:
4308
4309 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4310
4311 applied to:
4312
4313 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4314
4315 outputs:
4316
4317 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4318
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004319 - "set-status" replaces the response status code with <status> which must
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004320 be an integer between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be
4321 provided defined by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code
4322 will be used as a fallback.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004323
4324 Example:
4325
4326 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4327 http-response set-status 431
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004328 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4329 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004330
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004331 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4332 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4333 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4334 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4335 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
4336 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
4337 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
4338 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4339
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004340 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
4341 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
4342 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
4343 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
4344 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
4345 another equipment.
4346
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004347 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
4348 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4349 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4350 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
4351 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
4352 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
4353 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
4354 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4355
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004356 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
4357 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
4358 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
4359 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
4360 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
4361 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
4362 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
4363 admin privileges.
4364
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004365 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4366 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4367 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4368 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
4369 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4370 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4371 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
4372 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4373
4374 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4375 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4376 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4377 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4378 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
4379 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4380
4381 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4382 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4383 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4384 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4385 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4386 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4387
4388 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4389 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4390 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
4391 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
4392 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4393 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4394 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4395 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4396 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4397
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004398 - capture <sample> id <id> :
4399 captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and converts
4400 it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4401 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4402 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4403 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4404 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
4405 response header" for more information.
4406
4407 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing
4408 the string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4409 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by
4410 a previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4411 keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01004412 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
4413 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004414
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004415 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4416 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4417 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible
4418 on the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When
4419 a redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server
4420 are closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
4421
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004422 - set-var(<var-name>) expr:
4423 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4424 inline.
4425
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004426 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
4427 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01004428 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004429 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4430 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004431 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004432 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004433 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004434 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4435 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004436 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01004437 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
4438 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004439
4440 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4441 followed by some converters.
4442
4443 Example:
4444
4445 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4446
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004447 - unset-var(<var-name>) :
4448 Is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
4449
4450 Example:
4451
4452 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4453
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004454 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
4455 enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer to
4456 "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
4457 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make
4458 use of samples in response (eg. res.*, status etc.) and samples below
4459 Layer 6 (eg. ssl related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is
4460 not supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
4461
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004462 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
4463 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
4464 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
4465 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
4466 continues.
4467
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004468 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
4469 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
4470 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4471 the actions evaluation continues.
4472
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004473 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4474 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4475 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4476 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4477 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4478 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4479 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4480 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4481 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4482 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4483 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4484 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4485 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4486 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4487 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4488 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4489
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004490 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
4491
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08004492 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004493 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4494 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004495 rules.
4496
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004497 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4498 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4499 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4500 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
4501
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004502 Example:
4503 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
4504
4505 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4506
4507 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4508 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4509
4510 Example:
4511 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4512
4513 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4514
4515 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4516 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
4517
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004518 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4519 ACL usage.
4520
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02004521
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004522http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
4523 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
4524
4525 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4526 yes | no | yes | yes
4527
4528 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
4529 belongs to the session that initiated it. The downside is that between the
4530 response and the next request, the connection remains idle and is not used.
4531 In many cases for performance reasons it is desirable to make it possible to
4532 reuse these idle connections to serve other requests from different sessions.
4533 This directive allows to tune this behaviour.
4534
4535 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
4536
4537 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This is
4538 the default choice. It may be enforced to cancel a different
4539 strategy inherited from a defaults section or for
4540 troubleshooting. For example, if an old bogus application
4541 considers that multiple requests over the same connection come
4542 from the same client and it is not possible to fix the
4543 application, it may be desirable to disable connection sharing
4544 in a single backend. An example of such an application could
4545 be an old haproxy using cookie insertion in tunnel mode and
4546 not checking any request past the first one.
4547
4548 - "safe" : this is the recommended strategy. The first request of a
4549 session is always sent over its own connection, and only
4550 subsequent requests may be dispatched over other existing
4551 connections. This ensures that in case the server closes the
4552 connection when the request is being sent, the browser can
4553 decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly equivalent to
4554 regular keep-alive, there should be no side effects.
4555
4556 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
4557 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
4558 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
4559 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
4560 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
4561 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
4562 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
4563 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
4564 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
4565 downsides of rare connection failures.
4566
4567 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
4568 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
4569 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
4570 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
4571 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
4572 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
4573 consistent behaviour and will benefit from the connection
4574 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
4575 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
4576 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
4577 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
4578 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
4579
4580 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
4581 connection properties and compatiblities. Specifically :
4582 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependant value
4583 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared ;
4584
4585 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
4586 and are never shared ;
4587
4588 - connections receiving a status code 401 or 407 expect some authentication
4589 to be sent in return. Due to certain bogus authentication schemes (such
4590 as NTLM) relying on the connection, these connections are marked private
4591 and are never shared ;
4592
4593 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
4594 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
4595 may not last after all sessions are closed.
4596
4597 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
4598 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
4599 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
4600
4601 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
4602
4603
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004604http-send-name-header [<header>]
4605 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
4606
4607 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4608 yes | no | yes | yes
4609
4610 Arguments :
4611
4612 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
4613
4614 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
4615 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
4616 is added with the header string proved.
4617
4618 See also : "server"
4619
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004620id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02004621 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
4622 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4623 no | yes | yes | yes
4624 Arguments : none
4625
4626 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
4627 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
4628 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004629
4630
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004631ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4632 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
4633 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4634 no | yes | yes | yes
4635
4636 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
4637 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
4638 and running).
4639
4640 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4641 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
4642 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004643 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004644 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
4645
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004646 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4647 "unless" condition is met.
4648
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004649 Example:
4650 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
4651 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
4652 ignore-persist if url_static
4653
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004654 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
4655
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004656load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
4657 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
4658 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4659 yes | no | yes | yes
4660
4661 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
4662 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
4663 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
4664 reload occured. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
4665 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
4666 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
4667 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
4668 over the stats socket and redirect output.
4669
4670 The format of the file is versionned and is very specific. To understand it,
4671 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02004672 9.2 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004673
4674 Arguments:
4675 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
4676 named "server-state-file".
4677
4678 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
4679 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
4680 name is used as a file name.
4681
4682 none don't load any stat for this backend
4683
4684 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01004685 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
4686 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
4687 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
4688 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (eg: /etc/hosts)
4689 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004690
4691 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
4692 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
4693
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004694 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004695
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004696 global
4697 stats socket /tmp/socket
4698 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004699
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004700 defaults
4701 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004702
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004703 backend bk
4704 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4705 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004706
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004707
4708 Then one can run :
4709
4710 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
4711
4712 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
4713
4714 1
4715 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4716 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4717 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4718
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004719 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004720
4721 global
4722 stats socket /tmp/socket
4723 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
4724
4725 defaults
4726 load-server-state-from-file local
4727
4728 backend bk
4729 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4730 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
4731
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004732
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004733 Then one can run :
4734
4735 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
4736
4737 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
4738
4739 1
4740 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4741 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4742 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4743
4744 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
4745 "show servers state"
4746
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004747
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004748log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004749log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004750no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004751 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
4752 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4753 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004754
4755 Prefix :
4756 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
4757 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
4758 prefix does not allow arguments.
4759
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004760 Arguments :
4761 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
4762 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
4763 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
4764 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
4765 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
4766 parameter.
4767
4768 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
4769 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
4770
4771 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
4772 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4773 standard syslog port).
4774
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01004775 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
4776 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4777 standard syslog port).
4778
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004779 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
4780 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
4781 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
4782 appropriately writeable).
4783
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004784 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4785 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004786
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004787 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
4788 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
4789 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
4790 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
4791 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
4792 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
4793 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
4794 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
4795 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
4796 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
4797 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
4798
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004799 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
4800
4801 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
4802 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
4803 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
4804
4805 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
4806 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
4807 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004808 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
4809 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
4810 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
4811 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
4812 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004813
4814 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4815
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004816 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
4817 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
4818 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004819
4820 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
4821 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
4822 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
4823 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
4824
4825 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
4826 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004827
4828 Example :
4829 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004830 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
4831 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004832 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004833
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004834
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004835log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004836 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
4837 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4838 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004839
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004840 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
4841 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
4842 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
4843 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
4844 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004845
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02004846 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
4847 "option httplog" directives.
4848
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02004849log-format-sd <string>
4850 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
4851 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4852 yes | yes | yes | no
4853
4854 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
4855 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
4856 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
4857 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
4858 which covers the log format string in depth.
4859
4860 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
4861 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
4862
4863 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
4864 log format to "rfc5424".
4865
4866 Example :
4867 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
4868
4869
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01004870log-tag <string>
4871 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
4872 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4873 yes | yes | yes | yes
4874
4875 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
4876 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
4877 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
4878 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
4879 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
4880 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
4881 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
4882 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
4883 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004884
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02004885max-keep-alive-queue <value>
4886 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
4887 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4888 yes | no | yes | yes
4889
4890 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
4891 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
4892 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
4893 servers.
4894
4895 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
4896 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
4897 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
4898 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
4899 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
4900 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
4901 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
4902 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
4903 picking a different server.
4904
4905 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
4906 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
4907 even if they have to be queued.
4908
4909 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
4910 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
4911
4912
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004913maxconn <conns>
4914 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
4915 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4916 yes | yes | yes | no
4917 Arguments :
4918 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
4919 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
4920 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
4921 closes.
4922
4923 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
4924 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
4925 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
4926 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01004927 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
4928 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
4929 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
4930 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004931
4932 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
4933 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
4934 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
4935
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02004936 By default, this value is set to 2000.
4937
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004938 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
4939
4940
4941mode { tcp|http|health }
4942 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
4943 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4944 yes | yes | yes | yes
4945 Arguments :
4946 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
4947 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
4948 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
4949 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
4950
4951 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
4952 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
4953 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
4954 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
4955 brings HAProxy most of its value.
4956
4957 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004958 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
4959 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
4960 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
4961 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
4962 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
4963 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
4964 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004965
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004966 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
4967 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
4968 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004969
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004970 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004971 defaults http_instances
4972 mode http
4973
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004974 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004975
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004976
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004977monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004978 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004979 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4980 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004981 Arguments :
4982 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
4983 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004984 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004985 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
4986 backend and its backup.
4987
4988 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
4989 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
4990 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
4991 servers in a list of backends.
4992
4993 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
4994 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
4995 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
4996 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
4997 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
4998 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
4999 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005000 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
5001 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005002
5003 Example:
5004 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005005 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005006 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
5007 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
5008 monitor-uri /site_alive
5009 monitor fail if site_dead
5010
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005011 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005012
5013
5014monitor-net <source>
5015 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5016 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5017 yes | yes | yes | no
5018 Arguments :
5019 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5020 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5021 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5022 followed by a mask.
5023
5024 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5025 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005026 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005027 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5028
5029 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5030 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5031 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5032 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005033 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5034 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5035 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005036
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005037 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5038 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5039 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5040 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5041 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5042 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005043
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005044 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5045 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005046
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005047 Example :
5048 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5049 frontend www
5050 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5051
5052 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5053
5054
5055monitor-uri <uri>
5056 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5057 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5058 yes | yes | yes | no
5059 Arguments :
5060 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5061 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5062
5063 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5064 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5065 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5066 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5067 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5068 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5069 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5070 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5071
5072 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
5073 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
5074 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
5075 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
5076 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
5077 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
5078
5079 Example :
5080 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5081 frontend www
5082 mode http
5083 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5084
5085 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5086
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005087
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005088option abortonclose
5089no option abortonclose
5090 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5091 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5092 yes | no | yes | yes
5093 Arguments : none
5094
5095 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5096 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5097 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5098 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005099 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005100 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5101 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5102 encountered while delivering the response.
5103
5104 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5105 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5106 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5107 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5108 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5109 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005110 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005111 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005112 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005113 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5114 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5115 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5116
5117 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
5118 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
5119 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5120 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5121 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5122 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5123 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5124 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005125 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005126
5127 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5128 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5129
5130 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5131
5132
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005133option accept-invalid-http-request
5134no option accept-invalid-http-request
5135 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5136 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5137 yes | yes | yes | no
5138 Arguments : none
5139
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005140 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005141 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
5142 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
5143 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5144 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5145 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5146 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5147 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005148 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5149 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5150 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5151 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
5152 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005153 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005154 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5155 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5156 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005157
5158 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5159 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5160 been confirmed.
5161
5162 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5163 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005164 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5165 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005166 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5167
5168 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5169 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5170
5171 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5172 stats socket.
5173
5174
5175option accept-invalid-http-response
5176no option accept-invalid-http-response
5177 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5178 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5179 yes | no | yes | yes
5180 Arguments : none
5181
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005182 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005183 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
5184 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
5185 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5186 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5187 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5188 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5189 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005190 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5191 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5192 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005193
5194 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5195 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5196 been confirmed.
5197
5198 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5199 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5200 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5201 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5202
5203 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5204 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5205
5206 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5207 stats socket.
5208
5209
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005210option allbackups
5211no option allbackups
5212 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5213 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5214 yes | no | yes | yes
5215 Arguments : none
5216
5217 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5218 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5219 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5220 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5221 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5222 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5223 order between the backup servers anymore.
5224
5225 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5226 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5227
5228 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5229 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5230
5231
5232option checkcache
5233no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005234 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005235 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5236 yes | no | yes | yes
5237 Arguments : none
5238
5239 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5240 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005241 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005242 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5243 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005244 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005245
5246 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005247 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005248 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005249 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5250 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005251 to the client are :
5252 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005253 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005254 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005255 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
5256 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
5257 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5258 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5259 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5260 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5261 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5262 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5263 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5264 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5265 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5266
5267 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005268 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005269 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005270 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005271 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
5272
5273 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5274 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005275 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005276 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
5277
5278 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5279 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5280
5281
5282option clitcpka
5283no option clitcpka
5284 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5285 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5286 yes | yes | yes | no
5287 Arguments : none
5288
5289 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5290 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5291 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5292 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5293
5294 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5295 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5296 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5297 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5298
5299 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5300 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5301 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5302 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5303 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5304
5305 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5306
5307 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5308 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5309 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5310
5311 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5312 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5313
5314 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5315
5316
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005317option contstats
5318 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5319 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5320 yes | yes | yes | no
5321 Arguments : none
5322
5323 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5324 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5325 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5326 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01005327 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
5328 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
5329 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
5330 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
5331 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005332
5333
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005334option dontlog-normal
5335no option dontlog-normal
5336 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
5337 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5338 yes | yes | yes | no
5339 Arguments : none
5340
5341 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
5342 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
5343 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
5344 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
5345 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
5346 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
5347 logged.
5348
5349 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
5350 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
5351 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
5352
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005353 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005354 logging.
5355
5356
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005357option dontlognull
5358no option dontlognull
5359 Enable or disable logging of null connections
5360 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5361 yes | yes | yes | no
5362 Arguments : none
5363
5364 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
5365 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
5366 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
5367 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
5368 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
5369 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005370 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
5371 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
5372 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005373
5374 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
5375 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
5376 would not be logged.
5377
5378 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5379 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5380
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005381 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
5382 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005383
5384
5385option forceclose
5386no option forceclose
5387 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
5388 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01005389 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005390 Arguments : none
5391
5392 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
5393 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
5394 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
5395 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
5396 global session times in the logs.
5397
5398 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01005399 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005400 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005401
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005402 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
5403 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
5404 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
5405
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005406 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5407 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005408
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005409 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5410 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5411
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005412 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005413
5414
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005415option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005416 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
5417 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5418 yes | yes | yes | yes
5419 Arguments :
5420 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5421 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005422 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005423 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005424
5425 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
5426 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
5427 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
5428 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
5429 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
5430 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
5431 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005432 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
5433 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5434 possible that the client has already brought one.
5435
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005436 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005437 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005438 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
5439 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005440 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
5441 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005442
5443 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5444 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5445 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5446 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5447 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5448 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5449 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5450
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005451 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
5452 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
5453 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
5454 are under the control of the end-user.
5455
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005456 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005457 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5458 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005459 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
5460 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
5461 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005462
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005463 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005464 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
5465 frontend www
5466 mode http
5467 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
5468
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005469 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
5470 backend www
5471 mode http
5472 option forwardfor header X-Client
5473
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005474 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005475 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005476
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005477
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005478option http-buffer-request
5479no option http-buffer-request
5480 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
5481 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5482 yes | yes | yes | yes
5483 Arguments : none
5484
5485 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
5486 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
5487 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
5488 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
5489 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
5490 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
5491 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
5492 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005493 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005494 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
5495 default.
5496
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01005497 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005498
5499
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005500option http-ignore-probes
5501no option http-ignore-probes
5502 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
5503 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5504 yes | yes | yes | no
5505 Arguments : none
5506
5507 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
5508 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
5509 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
5510 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
5511 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
5512 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
5513 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
5514 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
5515 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
5516 was received over a connection before it was closed ;
5517 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation ;
5518 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
5519
5520 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
5521 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
5522 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
5523 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
5524 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
5525 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
5526 are often the only way to detect them.
5527
5528 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5529 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5530
5531 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
5532
5533
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005534option http-keep-alive
5535no option http-keep-alive
5536 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
5537 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5538 yes | yes | yes | yes
5539 Arguments : none
5540
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005541 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5542 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5543 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
5544 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
5545 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5546 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
5547 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
5548
5549 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
5550 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005551 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
5552 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
5553 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
5554 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
5555 situations where this option may be useful :
5556
5557 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
5558 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
5559
5560 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
5561 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
5562
5563 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
5564 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
5565 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
5566 request.
5567
5568 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
5569 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005570 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
5571 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
5572 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005573
5574 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
5575 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
5576
5577 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5578 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5579 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5580 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
5581 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5582 not set.
5583
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005584 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5585 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005586 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005587 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005588
5589 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005590 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
5591 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005592
5593
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005594option http-no-delay
5595no option http-no-delay
5596 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
5597 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5598 yes | yes | yes | yes
5599 Arguments : none
5600
5601 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
5602 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
5603 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
5604 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
5605 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
5606 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
5607 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
5608 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
5609 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
5610 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
5611 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
5612 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
5613 affected.
5614
5615 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
5616 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
5617 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
5618 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
5619 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
5620 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
5621 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
5622 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
5623 latency environments.
5624
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005625 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
5626
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005627
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005628option http-pretend-keepalive
5629no option http-pretend-keepalive
5630 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
5631 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5632 yes | yes | yes | yes
5633 Arguments : none
5634
5635 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
5636 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
5637 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
5638 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
5639 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
5640 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
5641 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
5642 consider the response complete.
5643
5644 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
5645 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
5646 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
5647 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
5648 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
5649 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
5650
5651 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
5652 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
5653 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
5654 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
5655 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
5656 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
5657 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
5658
5659 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5660 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005661 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02005662 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
5663 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005664
5665 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5666 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5667
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005668 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
5669 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005670
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005671
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005672option http-server-close
5673no option http-server-close
5674 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
5675 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5676 yes | yes | yes | yes
5677 Arguments : none
5678
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005679 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5680 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5681 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5682 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5683 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5684 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
5685 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
5686 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
5687 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
5688 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
5689 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00005690 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005691 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
5692 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
5693 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
5694 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005695
5696 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5697 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5698 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5699 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005700 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5701 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005702
5703 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5704 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005705 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
5706 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005707 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
5708 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005709
5710 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5711 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5712
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005713 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005714 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5715 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005716
5717
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005718option http-tunnel
5719no option http-tunnel
5720 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
5721 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5722 yes | yes | yes | yes
5723 Arguments : none
5724
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005725 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5726 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5727 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5728 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5729 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5730 "option http-tunnel".
5731
5732 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005733 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005734 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
5735 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
5736 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
5737 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
5738 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
5739 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
5740 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005741
5742 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5743 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5744
5745 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
5746 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5747 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
5748
5749
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005750option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005751no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005752 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
5753 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5754 yes | yes | yes | no
5755 Arguments : none
5756
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00005757 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005758 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
5759 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
5760 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
5761 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
5762 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
5763 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
5764
5765 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
5766 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005767 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
5768 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
5769 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005770
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01005771 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
5772 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
5773 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
5774 front of an existing proxy.
5775
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005776 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
5777
5778 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
5779 http-server-close".
5780
5781
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005782option httpchk
5783option httpchk <uri>
5784option httpchk <method> <uri>
5785option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
5786 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
5787 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5788 yes | no | yes | yes
5789 Arguments :
5790 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
5791 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
5792 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
5793 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
5794 ones.
5795
5796 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
5797 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5798 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5799
5800 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
5801 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
5802 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
5803 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
5804 after "\r\n" following the version string.
5805
5806 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
5807 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
5808 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
5809 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
5810 the lack of any response.
5811
5812 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
5813
5814 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
5815 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
5816 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
5817
5818 Examples :
5819 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
5820 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
5821 backend https_relay
5822 mode tcp
5823 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
5824 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
5825
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09005826 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
5827 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
5828 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005829
5830
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005831option httpclose
5832no option httpclose
5833 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
5834 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5835 yes | yes | yes | yes
5836 Arguments : none
5837
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005838 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5839 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5840 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5841 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005842 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005843 "option http-tunnel".
5844
5845 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
5846 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
5847 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
5848 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
5849 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
5850 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
5851 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
5852 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005853
5854 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005855 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01005856 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
5857 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
5858 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
5859 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
5860 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005861
5862 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5863 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005864 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
5865 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005866 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
5867 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005868
5869 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5870 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5871
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005872 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
5873 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005874
5875
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005876option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005877 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
5878 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5879 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005880 Arguments :
5881 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
5882 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
5883 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
5884 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
5885 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005886
5887 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5888 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5889 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
5890 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
5891 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
5892 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
5893 ports.
5894
5895 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5896
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01005897 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
5898 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005899
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005900 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
5901
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005902 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005903
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005904
5905option http_proxy
5906no option http_proxy
5907 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
5908 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5909 yes | yes | yes | yes
5910 Arguments : none
5911
5912 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
5913 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
5914 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
5915 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
5916 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
5917
5918 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
5919 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005920 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
5921 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005922
5923 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5924 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5925
5926 Example :
5927 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
5928 backend direct_forward
5929 option httpclose
5930 option http_proxy
5931
5932 See also : "option httpclose"
5933
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005934
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005935option independent-streams
5936no option independent-streams
5937 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005938 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5939 yes | yes | yes | yes
5940 Arguments : none
5941
5942 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
5943 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
5944 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
5945 receive data or not.
5946
5947 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
5948 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
5949 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
5950 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
5951 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
5952 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
5953 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
5954 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
5955 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
5956 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
5957 socket buffers.
5958
5959 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
5960 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
5961 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
5962 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
5963 slow lines, so use it with caution.
5964
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005965 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005966 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
5967 deprecated.
5968
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005969 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005970
5971
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02005972option ldap-check
5973 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
5974 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5975 yes | no | yes | yes
5976 Arguments : none
5977
5978 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
5979 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
5980 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
5981 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
5982
5983 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
5984 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
5985
5986 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
5987 configure it.
5988
5989 Example :
5990 option ldap-check
5991
5992 See also : "option httpchk"
5993
5994
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005995option external-check
5996 Use external processes for server health checks
5997 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5998 yes | no | yes | yes
5999
6000 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
6001 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
6002 command".
6003
6004 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
6005
6006 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
6007
6008
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006009option log-health-checks
6010no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006011 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006012 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6013 yes | no | yes | yes
6014 Arguments : none
6015
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006016 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6017 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6018 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006019
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006020 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6021 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6022 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6023 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6024 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6025
6026 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
6027 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006028
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006029 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6030 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6031 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006032
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006033
6034option log-separate-errors
6035no option log-separate-errors
6036 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6037 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6038 yes | yes | yes | no
6039 Arguments : none
6040
6041 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6042 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6043 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6044 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6045 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6046 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6047 provides very important information.
6048
6049 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6050 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6051 error logs.
6052
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006053 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006054 logging.
6055
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006056
6057option logasap
6058no option logasap
6059 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6060 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6061 yes | yes | yes | no
6062 Arguments : none
6063
6064 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6065 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6066 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6067 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6068 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6069 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6070 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006071 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006072 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6073 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6074
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006075 Examples :
6076 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6077 mode http
6078 option httplog
6079 option logasap
6080 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6081
6082 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6083 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6084 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6085 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6086
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006087 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006088 logging.
6089
6090
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006091option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006092 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006093 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6094 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006095 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006096 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6097 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006098 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006099
6100 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6101 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
6102 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
6103 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6104 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6105 in the MySQL table, like this :
6106
6107 USE mysql;
6108 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6109 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6110
6111 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
6112 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
6113 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6114 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6115 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6116 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6117 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6118 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6119 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6120
6121 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6122 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006123
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006124 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006125
6126 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6127 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6128 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6129 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006130 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6131 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006132
6133 See also: "option httpchk"
6134
6135
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006136option nolinger
6137no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006138 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006139 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6140 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006141 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006142
6143 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
6144 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6145 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6146 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6147 connections.
6148
6149 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6150 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6151 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6152 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6153 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6154 this too.
6155
6156 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6157 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6158 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6159
6160 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6161 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6162 for servers.
6163
6164 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6165 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6166
6167
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006168option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6169 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6170 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6171 yes | yes | yes | yes
6172 Arguments :
6173 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6174 matching <network>
6175 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6176 header name.
6177
6178 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6179 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6180 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6181 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6182 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6183 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6184 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6185 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6186 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6187 possible that the client has already brought one.
6188
6189 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6190 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6191 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6192 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6193 header and requires different one.
6194
6195 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6196 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6197 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6198 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6199 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6200 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6201 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6202
6203 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6204 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6205 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6206 both are defined.
6207
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006208 Examples :
6209 # Original Destination address
6210 frontend www
6211 mode http
6212 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6213
6214 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6215 backend www
6216 mode http
6217 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6218
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006219 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6220 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006221
6222
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006223option persist
6224no option persist
6225 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6226 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6227 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006228 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006229
6230 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6231 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6232 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6233 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6234 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6235 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6236 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6237 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6238 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6239 redirected to another valid server.
6240
6241 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6242 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6243
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006244 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006245
6246
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006247option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6248 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6249 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6250 yes | no | yes | yes
6251 Arguments :
6252 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6253 PostgreSQL server.
6254
6255 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6256 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6257 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6258 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6259
6260 See also: "option httpchk"
6261
6262
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006263option prefer-last-server
6264no option prefer-last-server
6265 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6266 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6267 yes | no | yes | yes
6268 Arguments : none
6269
6270 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6271 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6272 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6273 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6274 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6275 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6276 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6277 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6278 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006279 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6280 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
6281 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
6282 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
6283 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6284 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6285 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006286
6287 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6288 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6289
6290 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6291
6292
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006293option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006294option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006295no option redispatch
6296 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6297 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6298 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006299 Arguments :
6300 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6301 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6302 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
6303 N indicate a redispath is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
6304 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
6305 historical behaviour of redispatching on the last retry, a
6306 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6307 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6308 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6309
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006310
6311 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6312 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6313 be able to access the service anymore.
6314
6315 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
6316 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
6317
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006318 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006319 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6320 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006321
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006322 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
6323 "redisp" keywords.
6324
6325 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6326 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6327
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006328 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006329
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006330
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006331option redis-check
6332 Use redis health checks for server testing
6333 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6334 yes | no | yes | yes
6335 Arguments : none
6336
6337 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6338 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6339 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6340 find the "+PONG" response message.
6341
6342 Example :
6343 option redis-check
6344
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006345 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006346
6347
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006348option smtpchk
6349option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
6350 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
6351 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6352 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006353 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006354 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
6355 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
6356 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
6357
6358 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
6359 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
6360 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
6361
6362 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
6363 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
6364 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
6365 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
6366 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
6367 dead server.
6368
6369 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
6370 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
6371 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
6372 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
6373
6374 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
6375 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
6376 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6377 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006378 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006379
6380 Example :
6381 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
6382
6383 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
6384
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006385
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02006386option socket-stats
6387no option socket-stats
6388
6389 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
6390 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6391 yes | yes | yes | no
6392
6393 Arguments : none
6394
6395
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006396option splice-auto
6397no option splice-auto
6398 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
6399 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6400 yes | yes | yes | yes
6401 Arguments : none
6402
6403 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
6404 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
6405 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
6406 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006407 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006408 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
6409 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
6410 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
6411 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6412
6413 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
6414 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
6415 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
6416 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
6417 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
6418 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
6419 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
6420 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
6421 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
6422 keyword.
6423
6424 Example :
6425 option splice-auto
6426
6427 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6428 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6429
6430 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
6431 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6432
6433
6434option splice-request
6435no option splice-request
6436 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
6437 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6438 yes | yes | yes | yes
6439 Arguments : none
6440
6441 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006442 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006443 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6444 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6445 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6446 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6447
6448 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6449
6450 Example :
6451 option splice-request
6452
6453 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6454 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6455
6456 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
6457 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6458
6459
6460option splice-response
6461no option splice-response
6462 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
6463 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6464 yes | yes | yes | yes
6465 Arguments : none
6466
6467 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006468 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006469 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6470 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6471 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6472 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6473
6474 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6475
6476 Example :
6477 option splice-response
6478
6479 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6480 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6481
6482 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
6483 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6484
6485
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01006486option spop-check
6487 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
6488 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6489 no | no | no | yes
6490 Arguments : none
6491
6492 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
6493 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6494 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
6495 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
6496
6497 Example :
6498 option spop-check
6499
6500 See also : "option httpchk"
6501
6502
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006503option srvtcpka
6504no option srvtcpka
6505 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
6506 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6507 yes | no | yes | yes
6508 Arguments : none
6509
6510 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6511 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6512 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6513 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6514
6515 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6516 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6517 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6518 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6519
6520 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6521 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6522 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6523 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6524 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6525
6526 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6527
6528 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6529 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6530 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
6531
6532 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6533 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6534
6535 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
6536
6537
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006538option ssl-hello-chk
6539 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
6540 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6541 yes | no | yes | yes
6542 Arguments : none
6543
6544 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
6545 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
6546 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
6547 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
6548 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
6549 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
6550 hello message.
6551
6552 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
6553 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
6554 messages, which is appreciable.
6555
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006556 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
6557 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
6558 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006559
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006560 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
6561
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006562
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006563option tcp-check
6564 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
6565 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6566 yes | no | yes | yes
6567
6568 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
6569 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
6570
6571 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
6572 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
6573 attempt, which remains the default mode.
6574
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006575 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006576 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
6577 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
6578 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
6579 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
6580 only.
6581
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006582 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006583 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
6584 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
6585 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
6586 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
6587
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006588 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006589 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
6590 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006591 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006592 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
6593 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
6594 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
6595 the respective protocols.
6596 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
6597 analysed.
6598
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006599 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
6600 script.
6601
6602 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
6603 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
6604 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
6605 The "comment" is of course optional.
6606
6607
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006608 Examples :
6609 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
6610 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006611 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006612
6613 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
6614 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006615 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006616
6617 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
6618 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006619 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006620 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006621 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006622 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02006623 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006624 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006625 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
6626 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006627 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006628 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
6629 tcp-check expect string +OK
6630
6631 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
6632 (send many headers before analyzing)
6633 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006634 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006635 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
6636 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
6637 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
6638 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006639 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006640
6641
6642 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
6643
6644
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006645option tcp-smart-accept
6646no option tcp-smart-accept
6647 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
6648 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6649 yes | yes | yes | no
6650 Arguments : none
6651
6652 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
6653 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
6654 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
6655 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
6656 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
6657 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
6658
6659 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
6660 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
6661 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
6662 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
6663
6664 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
6665 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
6666 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
6667 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
6668
6669 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
6670 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
6671 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
6672
6673 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
6674 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
6675 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
6676
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02006677 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
6678
6679
6680option tcp-smart-connect
6681no option tcp-smart-connect
6682 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
6683 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6684 yes | no | yes | yes
6685 Arguments : none
6686
6687 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
6688 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
6689 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
6690 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
6691 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
6692
6693 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
6694 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
6695 complex.
6696
6697 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
6698 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
6699 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
6700
6701 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6702 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6703
6704 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
6705
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006706
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006707option tcpka
6708 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
6709 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6710 yes | yes | yes | yes
6711 Arguments : none
6712
6713 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6714 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6715 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6716 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6717
6718 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6719 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6720 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6721 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6722
6723 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6724 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6725 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6726 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6727 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6728
6729 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6730
6731 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
6732 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
6733 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
6734 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
6735 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
6736 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
6737 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
6738 backends.
6739
6740 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
6741
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006742
6743option tcplog
6744 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
6745 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6746 yes | yes | yes | yes
6747 Arguments : none
6748
6749 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6750 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6751 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
6752 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
6753 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
6754 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
6755 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
6756 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
6757
6758 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
6759
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006760 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6761
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006762 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006763
6764
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006765option transparent
6766no option transparent
6767 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6768 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006769 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006770 Arguments : none
6771
6772 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
6773 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6774 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6775 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6776 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6777 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6778 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6779 appropriate server.
6780
6781 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6782 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6783
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01006784 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006785 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006786
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006787
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006788external-check command <command>
6789 Executable to run when performing an external-check
6790 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6791 yes | no | yes | yes
6792
6793 Arguments :
6794 <command> is the external command to run
6795
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006796 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
6797
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006798 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006799
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006800 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
6801 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
6802 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
6803 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
6804 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
6805 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006806
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01006807 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
6808
6809 Environment variables :
6810 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
6811 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
6812
6813 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
6814
6815 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
6816
6817 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
6818 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
6819 for a UNIX socket).
6820
6821 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
6822
6823 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
6824
6825 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
6826
6827 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
6828
6829 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
6830
6831 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
6832 socket).
6833
6834 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
6835 the command may be set using "external-check path".
6836
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006837 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
6838 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
6839 failed.
6840
6841 Example :
6842 external-check command /bin/true
6843
6844 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
6845
6846
6847external-check path <path>
6848 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
6849 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6850 yes | no | yes | yes
6851
6852 Arguments :
6853 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
6854
6855 The default path is "".
6856
6857 Example :
6858 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
6859
6860 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
6861 "external-check command"
6862
6863
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006864persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02006865persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006866 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
6867 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6868 yes | no | yes | yes
6869 Arguments :
6870 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006871 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
6872 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006873
6874 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
6875 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
6876 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
6877 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
6878 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
6879 forwarded to this server.
6880
6881 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
6882 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
6883 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006884 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006885 a single "listen" section.
6886
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006887 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
6888 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
6889 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
6890
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006891 Example :
6892 listen tse-farm
6893 bind :3389
6894 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
6895 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6896 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
6897 # apply RDP cookie persistence
6898 persist rdp-cookie
6899 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006900 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006901 balance rdp-cookie
6902 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
6903 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
6904
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09006905 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
6906 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006907
6908
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006909rate-limit sessions <rate>
6910 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
6911 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6912 yes | yes | yes | no
6913 Arguments :
6914 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
6915 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
6916
6917 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
6918 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
6919 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
6920 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
6921 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
6922 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
6923
6924 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
6925 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
6926 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
6927 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
6928
6929 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
6930 listen smtp
6931 mode tcp
6932 bind :25
6933 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02006934 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006935
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02006936 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
6937 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
6938 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006939
6940 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
6941
6942
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006943redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6944redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6945redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006946 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
6947 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6948 no | yes | yes | yes
6949
6950 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01006951 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006952
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006953 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006954 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006955 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
6956 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
6957 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006958
6959 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
6960 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
6961 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
6962 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
6963 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006964 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
6965 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
6966 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
6967 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006968
6969 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
6970 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
6971 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
6972 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
6973 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
6974 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006975 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006976 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006977 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
6978 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
6979 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006980
6981 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006982 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
6983 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
6984 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02006985 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006986 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
6987 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
6988 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
6989 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006990
6991 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
6992 expected behaviour of a redirection :
6993
6994 - "drop-query"
6995 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
6996 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
6997 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
6998 with a location-type redirect.
6999
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007000 - "append-slash"
7001 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
7002 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
7003 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
7004 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
7005
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007006 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
7007 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
7008 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
7009 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7010 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7011 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7012 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7013
7014 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7015 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7016 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7017 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7018 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7019 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7020 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007021
7022 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7023 acl clear dst_port 80
7024 acl secure dst_port 8080
7025 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007026 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007027 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007028 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7029
7030 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007031 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7032 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7033 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007034 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007035
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007036 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7037 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7038 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7039
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007040 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007041 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007042
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007043 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007044 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7045 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7046 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007047
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007048 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007049
7050
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007051redisp (deprecated)
7052redispatch (deprecated)
7053 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7054 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7055 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007056 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007057
7058 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7059 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7060 be able to access the service anymore.
7061
7062 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
7063 redistribute them to a working server.
7064
7065 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
7066 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7067 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007068
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007069 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
7070 "option redispatch" instead.
7071
7072 See also : "option redispatch"
7073
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007074
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007075reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007076 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
7077 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7078 no | yes | yes | yes
7079 Arguments :
7080 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7081 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007082 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007083
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007084 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7085 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7086
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007087 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7088 the last header of an HTTP request.
7089
7090 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7091 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7092 responses.
7093
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007094 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
7095 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
7096 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
7097
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007098 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
7099 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007100
7101
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007102reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7103reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007104 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7105 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7106 no | yes | yes | yes
7107 Arguments :
7108 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7109 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7110 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7111 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7112 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7113 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
7114 ignores case.
7115
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007116 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7117 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7118
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007119 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7120 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
7121 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7122 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007123 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007124
7125 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7126 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7127
7128 Example :
7129 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
7130 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7131 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7132
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007133 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
7134 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007135
7136
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007137reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7138reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007139 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
7140 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7141 no | yes | yes | yes
7142 Arguments :
7143 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7144 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7145 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7146 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7147 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
7148 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
7149
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007150 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7151 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7152
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007153 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
7154 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
7155 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
7156 next servers.
7157
7158 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7159 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7160 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7161
7162 Example :
7163 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
7164 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
7165 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
7166
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007167 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
7168 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007169
7170
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007171reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7172reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007173 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7174 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7175 no | yes | yes | yes
7176 Arguments :
7177 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7178 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7179 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7180 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7181 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7182 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
7183 case.
7184
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007185 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7186 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7187
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007188 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7189 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
7190 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7191 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007192 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007193
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007194 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007195 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007196 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007197
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007198 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7199 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7200
7201 Example :
7202 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
7203 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7204 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7205
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007206 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7207 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007208
7209
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007210reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7211reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007212 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
7213 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7214 no | yes | yes | yes
7215 Arguments :
7216 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7217 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7218 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7219 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7220 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7221 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
7222 case.
7223
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007224 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7225 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7226
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007227 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7228 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
7229 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
7230 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7231
7232 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7233 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7234
7235 Example :
7236 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
7237 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
7238 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7239 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7240
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007241 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7242 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007243
7244
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007245reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7246reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007247 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
7248 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7249 no | yes | yes | yes
7250 Arguments :
7251 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7252 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7253 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7254 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7255 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
7256 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
7257
7258 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7259 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7260 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7261 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007262 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007263
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007264 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7265 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7266
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007267 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
7268 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
7269 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
7270
7271 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7272 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7273 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7274 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
7275 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7276
7277 Example :
7278 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007279 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007280 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
7281 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
7282
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007283 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
7284 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007285
7286
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007287reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7288reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007289 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
7290 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7291 no | yes | yes | yes
7292 Arguments :
7293 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7294 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7295 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7296 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7297 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7298 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
7299 ignores case.
7300
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007301 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7302 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7303
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007304 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7305 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007306 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
7307 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
7308 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007309 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
7310 not set.
7311
7312 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
7313 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
7314 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
7315 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
7316 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
7317
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007318 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007319 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
7320 # block all others.
7321 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
7322 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
7323
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007324 # block bad guys
7325 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
7326 reqitarpit . if badguys
7327
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007328 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
7329 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007330
7331
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007332retries <value>
7333 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7334 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7335 yes | no | yes | yes
7336 Arguments :
7337 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7338 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7339 default value is 3.
7340
7341 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7342 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7343 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7344
7345 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007346 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7347 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007348
7349 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7350 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7351
7352 See also : "option redispatch"
7353
7354
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007355rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007356 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
7357 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7358 no | yes | yes | yes
7359 Arguments :
7360 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7361 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007362 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007363
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007364 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7365 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7366
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007367 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7368 the last header of an HTTP response.
7369
7370 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7371 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7372 responses.
7373
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007374 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
7375 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007376
7377
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007378rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7379rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007380 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
7381 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7382 no | yes | yes | yes
7383 Arguments :
7384 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7385 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7386 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7387 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7388 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7389 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
7390 ignores case.
7391
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007392 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7393 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7394
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007395 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
7396 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007397 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007398 client.
7399
7400 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7401 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7402 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7403
7404 Example :
7405 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02007406 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007407
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007408 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
7409 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007410
7411
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007412rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7413rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007414 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
7415 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7416 no | yes | yes | yes
7417 Arguments :
7418 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7419 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7420 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7421 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7422 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7423 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
7424 ignores case.
7425
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007426 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7427 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7428
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007429 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7430 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
7431 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
7432 case-sensitive.
7433
7434 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007435 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
7436 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
7437 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007438
7439 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7440 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
7441
7442 Example :
7443 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
7444 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
7445
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007446 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
7447 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007448
7449
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007450rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7451rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007452 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
7453 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7454 no | yes | yes | yes
7455 Arguments :
7456 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7457 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7458 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7459 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7460 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7461 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
7462 ignores case.
7463
7464 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7465 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7466 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7467 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007468 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007469
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007470 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7471 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7472
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007473 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
7474 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
7475 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
7476
7477 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7478 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7479 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7480 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
7481 are not case-sensitive.
7482
7483 Example :
7484 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
7485 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
7486
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007487 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
7488 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007489
7490
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007491server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007492 Declare a server in a backend
7493 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7494 no | no | yes | yes
7495 Arguments :
7496 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02007497 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007498 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007499
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007500 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7501 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7502 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7503 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007504 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7505 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7506 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
7507 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
7508 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007509 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
7510 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
7511 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
7512 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
7513 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7514 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7515 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007516 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007517 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7518 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01007519 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
7520 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007521
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007522 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007523 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
7524 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
7525 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
7526 adding this value to the client's port.
7527
7528 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
7529 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007530 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007531
7532 Examples :
7533 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
7534 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007535 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007536 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
7537 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
7538 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007539
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02007540 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
7541 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
7542 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
7543 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
7544 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
7545
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007546 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
7547 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007548
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007549server-state-file-name [<file>]
7550 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
7551 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
7552 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
7553 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
7554 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
7555 global directive "server-state-file-base".
7556
7557 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
7558 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
7559
7560 global
7561 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
7562
7563 backend bk
7564 load-server-state-from-file
7565
7566 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
7567 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007568
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02007569server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
7570 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
7571 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
7572 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7573 no | no | yes | yes
7574
7575 Arguments:
7576 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
7577
7578 <num | range>
7579 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
7580 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
7581 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
7582 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
7583
7584 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
7585
7586 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
7587
7588 <params*>
7589 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
7590 keyword.
7591
7592 Examples:
7593 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
7594 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
7595 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
7596
7597 # or
7598 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
7599
7600 # would be equivalent to:
7601 server srv1 google.com:80 check
7602 server srv2 google.com:80 check
7603 server srv3 google.com:80 check
7604
7605
7606
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007607source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007608source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007609source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007610 Set the source address for outgoing connections
7611 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7612 yes | no | yes | yes
7613 Arguments :
7614 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
7615 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007616
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007617 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007618 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
7619 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
7620 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
7621 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
7622 supported prefixes are :
7623 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7624 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7625 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007626 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02007627 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7628 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007629
7630 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
7631 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007632 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
7633 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
7634 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007635
7636 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
7637 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
7638 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
7639 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
7640 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
7641 <addr>.
7642
7643 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
7644 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
7645 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
7646 port.
7647
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007648 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
7649 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
7650 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
7651 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01007652 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007653 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
7654 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
7655 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
7656 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
7657 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
7658 HTTP header.
7659
7660 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
7661 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007662 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007663 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
7664 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
7665 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
7666 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
7667 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
7668 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
7669 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
7670
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007671 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
7672 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
7673 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
7674 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
7675 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
7676 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
7677
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007678 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
7679 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
7680 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
7681 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
7682
7683 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
7684 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
7685 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
7686 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
7687 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
7688 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
7689
7690 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
7691 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
7692 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
7693 there are two methods :
7694
7695 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
7696 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
7697 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
7698 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
7699 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
7700 of the client ranges may be used.
7701
7702 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
7703 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
7704 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
7705 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
7706 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
7707 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
7708 same session.
7709
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007710 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
7711 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
7712 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007713 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007714
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02007715 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
7716
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007717 Examples :
7718 backend private
7719 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
7720 source 192.168.1.200
7721
7722 backend transparent_ssl1
7723 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
7724 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7725
7726 backend transparent_ssl2
7727 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
7728 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
7729 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
7730
7731 backend transparent_ssl3
7732 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
7733 # is more conntrack-friendly.
7734 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7735
7736 backend transparent_smtp
7737 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
7738 # with Tproxy version 4.
7739 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
7740
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007741 backend transparent_http
7742 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
7743 # proxy.
7744 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
7745
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007746 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007747 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
7748
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007749
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007750srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7751 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7752 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7753 yes | no | yes | yes
7754 Arguments :
7755 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7756 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7757 as explained at the top of this document.
7758
7759 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7760 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7761 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7762 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7763 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7764 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7765 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7766
7767 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7768 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7769 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7770 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7771 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007772 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007773 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007774 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007775
7776 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7777 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7778 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7779 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7780 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7781 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7782
7783 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
7784 Please use "timeout server" instead.
7785
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007786 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
7787 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007788
7789
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007790stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
7791 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
7792 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007793 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007794
7795 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
7796 matched.
7797
7798 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
7799 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
7800
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007801 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7802 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7803 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7804
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01007805 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
7806 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
7807 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
7808 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007809
7810 Example :
7811 # statistics admin level only for localhost
7812 backend stats_localhost
7813 stats enable
7814 stats admin if LOCALHOST
7815
7816 Example :
7817 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
7818 backend stats_auth
7819 stats enable
7820 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
7821 stats admin if TRUE
7822
7823 Example :
7824 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
7825 userlist stats-auth
7826 group admin users admin
7827 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
7828 group readonly users haproxy
7829 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
7830
7831 backend stats_auth
7832 stats enable
7833 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
7834 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
7835 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
7836 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
7837
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007838 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
7839 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7840 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007841
7842
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007843stats auth <user>:<passwd>
7844 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
7845 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007846 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007847 Arguments :
7848 <user> is a user name to grant access to
7849
7850 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
7851
7852 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
7853 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
7854 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
7855 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
7856 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
7857 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
7858
7859 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
7860 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
7861 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007862 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007863
7864 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
7865 report using "stats scope".
7866
7867 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7868 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7869 unobvious parameters.
7870
7871 Example :
7872 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7873 backend public_www
7874 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7875 stats enable
7876 stats hide-version
7877 stats scope .
7878 stats uri /admin?stats
7879 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7880 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7881 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7882
7883 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7884 backend private_monitoring
7885 stats enable
7886 stats uri /admin?stats
7887 stats refresh 5s
7888
7889 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
7890
7891
7892stats enable
7893 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
7894 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007895 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007896 Arguments : none
7897
7898 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
7899 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
7900 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
7901 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
7902 - stats auth : no authentication
7903 - stats scope : no restriction
7904
7905 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7906 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7907 unobvious parameters.
7908
7909 Example :
7910 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7911 backend public_www
7912 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7913 stats enable
7914 stats hide-version
7915 stats scope .
7916 stats uri /admin?stats
7917 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7918 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7919 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7920
7921 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7922 backend private_monitoring
7923 stats enable
7924 stats uri /admin?stats
7925 stats refresh 5s
7926
7927 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7928
7929
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007930stats hide-version
7931 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007932 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007933 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007934 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007935
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007936 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
7937 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
7938 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
7939 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
7940 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
7941 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007942
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007943 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7944 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7945 unobvious parameters.
7946
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007947 Example :
7948 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7949 backend public_www
7950 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007951 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007952 stats hide-version
7953 stats scope .
7954 stats uri /admin?stats
7955 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7956 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7957 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007958
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007959 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7960 backend private_monitoring
7961 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007962 stats uri /admin?stats
7963 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01007964
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007965 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007966
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01007967
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02007968stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
7969 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7970 Access control for statistics
7971
7972 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7973 no | no | yes | yes
7974
7975 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
7976 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
7977 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
7978 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
7979 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
7980 should be asked to enter a username and password.
7981
7982 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
7983 instance.
7984
7985 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
7986 about ACL usage.
7987
7988
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007989stats realm <realm>
7990 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
7991 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007992 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007993 Arguments :
7994 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
7995 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
7996 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
7997
7998 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
7999 using a backslash ('\').
8000
8001 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
8002 only related to authentication.
8003
8004 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8005 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8006 unobvious parameters.
8007
8008 Example :
8009 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8010 backend public_www
8011 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8012 stats enable
8013 stats hide-version
8014 stats scope .
8015 stats uri /admin?stats
8016 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8017 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8018 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8019
8020 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8021 backend private_monitoring
8022 stats enable
8023 stats uri /admin?stats
8024 stats refresh 5s
8025
8026 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8027
8028
8029stats refresh <delay>
8030 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8031 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008032 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008033 Arguments :
8034 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8035 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8036 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8037 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8038 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8039 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8040
8041 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8042 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8043 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8044 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8045
8046 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8047 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8048 unobvious parameters.
8049
8050 Example :
8051 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8052 backend public_www
8053 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8054 stats enable
8055 stats hide-version
8056 stats scope .
8057 stats uri /admin?stats
8058 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8059 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8060 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8061
8062 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8063 backend private_monitoring
8064 stats enable
8065 stats uri /admin?stats
8066 stats refresh 5s
8067
8068 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8069
8070
8071stats scope { <name> | "." }
8072 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8073 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008074 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008075 Arguments :
8076 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8077 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8078 section in which the statement appears.
8079
8080 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8081 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8082 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8083 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8084 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8085 exists.
8086
8087 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8088 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8089 unobvious parameters.
8090
8091 Example :
8092 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8093 backend public_www
8094 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8095 stats enable
8096 stats hide-version
8097 stats scope .
8098 stats uri /admin?stats
8099 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8100 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8101 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8102
8103 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8104 backend private_monitoring
8105 stats enable
8106 stats uri /admin?stats
8107 stats refresh 5s
8108
8109 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8110
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008111
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008112stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008113 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8114 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008115 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008116
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008117 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008118 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8119
8120 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8121 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8122
8123 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8124 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008125 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008126
8127 Example :
8128 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8129 backend private_monitoring
8130 stats enable
8131 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8132 stats uri /admin?stats
8133 stats refresh 5s
8134
8135 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8136 global section.
8137
8138
8139stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008140 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8141 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8142 yes | yes | yes | yes
8143 Arguments : none
8144
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008145 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008146 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8147 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8148 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8149 - IP (socket, server)
8150 - cookie (backend, server)
8151
8152 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8153 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008154 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008155
8156 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8157
8158
8159stats show-node [ <name> ]
8160 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8161 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008162 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008163 Arguments:
8164 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8165 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8166
8167 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8168 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008169 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008170
8171 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8172 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8173 unobvious parameters.
8174
8175 Example:
8176 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8177 backend private_monitoring
8178 stats enable
8179 stats show-node Europe-1
8180 stats uri /admin?stats
8181 stats refresh 5s
8182
8183 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8184 section.
8185
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008186
8187stats uri <prefix>
8188 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8189 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008190 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008191 Arguments :
8192 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8193 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8194 query string.
8195
8196 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8197 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8198 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8199 possible to reach it in the application.
8200
8201 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008202 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008203 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8204 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8205 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8206 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8207
8208 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8209 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8210 an address or a port to statistics only.
8211
8212 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8213 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8214 unobvious parameters.
8215
8216 Example :
8217 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8218 backend public_www
8219 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8220 stats enable
8221 stats hide-version
8222 stats scope .
8223 stats uri /admin?stats
8224 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8225 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8226 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8227
8228 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8229 backend private_monitoring
8230 stats enable
8231 stats uri /admin?stats
8232 stats refresh 5s
8233
8234 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8235
8236
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008237stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8238 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008239 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008240 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008241
8242 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008243 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008244 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
8245 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
8246 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8247
8248 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8249 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8250 the "stick-table" statement.
8251
8252 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8253 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8254 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8255 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8256 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8257
8258 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8259 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8260 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8261 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8262 transformation rules.
8263
8264 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8265 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8266 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8267 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8268 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8269 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8270 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8271
8272 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8273 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8274 ACL based conditions.
8275
8276 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8277 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8278 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8279 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8280
8281 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8282 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8283 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8284 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8285
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008286 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8287 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8288 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8289
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008290 Example :
8291 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8292 # last 30 minutes
8293 backend pop
8294 mode tcp
8295 balance roundrobin
8296 stick store-request src
8297 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8298 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8299 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8300
8301 backend smtp
8302 mode tcp
8303 balance roundrobin
8304 stick match src table pop
8305 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8306 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8307
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008308 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008309 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008310
8311
8312stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8313 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8314 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8315 no | no | yes | yes
8316
8317 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8318 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8319 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8320 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8321
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008322 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8323 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8324 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8325
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008326 Examples :
8327 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008328 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008329
8330 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8331 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8332 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8333
8334
8335 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8336 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8337 backend http
8338 mode http
8339 balance roundrobin
8340 stick on src table https
8341 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8342 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8343 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8344
8345 backend https
8346 mode tcp
8347 balance roundrobin
8348 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8349 stick on src
8350 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8351 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8352
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008353 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008354
8355
8356stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8357 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8358 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8359 no | no | yes | yes
8360
8361 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008362 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008363 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
8364 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8365 server is selected.
8366
8367 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8368 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8369 the "stick-table" statement.
8370
8371 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8372 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8373 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8374 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8375 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8376 address.
8377
8378 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8379 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8380 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8381 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8382 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8383 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8384 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8385 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8386 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8387 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8388
8389 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8390 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8391 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8392 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8393 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8394 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8395 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8396
8397 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8398 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8399 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8400 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8401
8402 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8403 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8404 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8405 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8406 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8407 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008408 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8409 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8410 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8411 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8412 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8413 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008414
8415 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8416 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8417 the request.
8418
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008419 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8420 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8421 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8422
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008423 Example :
8424 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8425 # last 30 minutes
8426 backend pop
8427 mode tcp
8428 balance roundrobin
8429 stick store-request src
8430 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8431 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8432 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8433
8434 backend smtp
8435 mode tcp
8436 balance roundrobin
8437 stick match src table pop
8438 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8439 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8440
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008441 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008442 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008443
8444
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008445stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008446 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8447 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008448 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008449 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008450 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008451
8452 Arguments :
8453 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8454 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8455 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8456 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8457
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008458 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8459 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8460 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8461 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8462
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008463 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8464 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8465 instance.
8466
8467 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8468 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8469 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8470 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8471 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8472 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008473 to 32 characters.
8474
8475 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8476 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8477 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008478 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008479 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8480 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008481
8482 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008483 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8484 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008485 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8486 increase.
8487
8488 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008489 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
8490 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
8491 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008492
8493 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
8494 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
8495 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
8496 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
8497 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
8498 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8499 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8500 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
8501 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
8502 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
8503 parameter (see below).
8504
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008505 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
8506 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
8507 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
8508 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
8509 soft restart.
8510
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02008511 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
8512 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008513
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008514 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
8515 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
8516 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
8517 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
8518 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008519 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008520 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
8521 if not expiration delay is specified.
8522
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008523 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
8524 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
8525 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
8526 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008527 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
8528 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
8529 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
8530 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
8531 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
8532 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
8533 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
8534 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
8535 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
8536 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
8537 types and their arguments.
8538
8539 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
8540 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
8541 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
8542 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
8543
8544 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8545 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8546 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
8547 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
8548
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008549 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
8550 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8551 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
8552 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
8553 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
8554 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
8555
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008556 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8557 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
8558 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
8559 they were received.
8560
8561 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8562 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
8563 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
8564 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
8565 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
8566
8567 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8568 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8569 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8570 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
8571 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8572
8573 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8574 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
8575 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
8576
8577 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8578 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8579 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8580 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
8581 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8582
8583 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8584 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
8585 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
8586 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
8587 the client side.
8588
8589 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8590 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8591 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8592 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
8593 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
8594 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
8595 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
8596
8597 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8598 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
8599 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
8600 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
8601 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
8602 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
8603 (eg: vulnerability scan).
8604
8605 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8606 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8607 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8608 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
8609 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
8610 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8611
8612 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8613 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
8614 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
8615 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
8616
8617 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8618 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8619 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8620 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8621 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8622 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
8623 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
8624 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
8625 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
8626 recommended for better fairness.
8627
8628 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8629 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
8630 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
8631 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
8632
8633 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
8634 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8635 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8636 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8637 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8638 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
8639 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
8640 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
8641 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
8642 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008643
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008644 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
8645 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008646 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
8647 reference it.
8648
8649 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
8650 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01008651 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
8652 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
8653 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008654
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008655 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
8656 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
8657 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
8658 something that can be ignored.
8659
8660 Example:
8661 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
8662 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
8663 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
8664 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
8665
8666 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01008667 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008668
8669
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008670stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01008671 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008672 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8673 no | no | yes | yes
8674
8675 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008676 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008677 describes what elements of the response or connection will
8678 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8679 server is selected.
8680
8681 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8682 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8683 the "stick-table" statement.
8684
8685 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8686 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8687 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
8688 when the response is a SSL server hello.
8689
8690 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8691 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
8692 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
8693 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
8694 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
8695 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008696 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008697 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
8698 rules.
8699
8700 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8701 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8702 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8703 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8704 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8705 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8706 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8707
8708 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
8709 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8710 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
8711 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8712
8713 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
8714 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8715 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8716 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8717 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8718 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008719 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
8720 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8721 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8722 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8723 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8724 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
8725 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
8726 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
8727 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008728
8729 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
8730
8731 Example :
8732 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
8733 backend https
8734 mode tcp
8735 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008736 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008737 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008738
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008739 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
8740 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
8741
8742 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
8743 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8744 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
8745
8746 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
8747 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008748
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008749 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
8750 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
8751 # at offset 44.
8752
8753 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
8754 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
8755
8756 # Learn on response if server hello.
8757 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008758
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008759 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8760 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8761
8762 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
8763 extraction.
8764
8765
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008766tcp-check connect [params*]
8767 Opens a new connection
8768 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8769 no | no | yes | yes
8770
8771 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
8772 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
8773 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
8774
8775 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
8776 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
8777 of the sequence.
8778
8779 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
8780 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
8781 do.
8782
8783 Parameters :
8784 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
8785 use the TCP connection.
8786
8787 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
8788 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
8789 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
8790
8791 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
8792
8793 ssl opens a ciphered connection
8794
8795 Examples:
8796 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
8797 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
8798 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
8799 option tcp-check
8800 tcp-check connect
8801 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8802 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8803 tcp-check send \r\n
8804 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8805 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
8806 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8807 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8808 tcp-check send \r\n
8809 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8810 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
8811
8812 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
8813 option tcp-check
8814 tcp-check connect port 110
8815 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8816 tcp-check connect port 143
8817 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8818 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
8819
8820 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
8821
8822
8823tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
8824 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
8825 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8826 no | no | yes | yes
8827
8828 Arguments :
8829 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
8830 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
8831 binary.
8832 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
8833 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
8834 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
8835
8836 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
8837 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
8838 with the usual backslash ('\').
8839 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
8840 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
8841 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
8842 used upper or lower case.
8843
8844
8845 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
8846
8847 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
8848 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8849 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
8850 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8851 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
8852 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
8853 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
8854 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
8855
8856 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
8857 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8858 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
8859 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8860 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
8861 expression.
8862
8863 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
8864 in the response buffer. A health check response will
8865 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
8866 this exact hexadecimal string.
8867 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
8868
8869 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
8870 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
8871 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
8872 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
8873 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
8874 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
8875 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
8876 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
8877 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
8878 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
8879 the null character.
8880
8881 Examples :
8882 # perform a POP check
8883 option tcp-check
8884 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8885
8886 # perform an IMAP check
8887 option tcp-check
8888 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8889
8890 # look for the redis master server
8891 option tcp-check
8892 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008893 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008894 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8895 tcp-check expect string role:master
8896 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8897 tcp-check expect string +OK
8898
8899
8900 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
8901 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
8902
8903
8904tcp-check send <data>
8905 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8906 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8907 no | no | yes | yes
8908
8909 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8910 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8911
8912 Examples :
8913 # look for the redis master server
8914 option tcp-check
8915 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8916 tcp-check expect string role:master
8917
8918 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8919 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
8920
8921
8922tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
8923 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
8924 tcp health check
8925 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8926 no | no | yes | yes
8927
8928 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8929 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8930 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
8931 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
8932 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
8933 hexadecimal string.
8934 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
8935
8936 Examples :
8937 # redis check in binary
8938 option tcp-check
8939 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
8940 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
8941
8942
8943 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8944 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
8945
8946
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008947tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8948 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008949 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8950 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008951 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02008952 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
8953 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008954
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008955 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008956
8957 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
8958 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008959 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
8960 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
8961 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
8962 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
8963 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
8964 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008965
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008966 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
8967 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
8968 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
8969 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008970
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008971 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008972 - accept :
8973 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8974 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8975 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008976
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008977 - reject :
8978 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8979 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8980 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
8981 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
8982 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
8983 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
8984 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
8985 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
8986 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
8987 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
8988 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02008989 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008990
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008991 - expect-proxy layer4 :
8992 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
8993 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
8994 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
8995 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
8996 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
8997 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
8998 hosts.
8999
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01009000 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
9001 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
9002 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
9003 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
9004 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
9005 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
9006 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
9007 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
9008
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009009 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9010 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9011 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9012 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9013 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9014 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9015 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9016 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9017 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009018 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9019 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009020
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009021 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009022 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02009023 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009024 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009025 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9026 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009027 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009028 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
9029 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
9030 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
9031 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
9032 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009033
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009034 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009035 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009036 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009037 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
9038 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9039 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9040 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009041
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009042 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9043 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9044 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9045 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009046
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009047 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9048 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9049 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9050 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9051 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009052 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9053 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9054 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9055 layer7 information is extracted.
9056
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009057 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9058 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9059 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9060 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9061 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009062
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009063 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9064 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9065 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9066 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9067
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009068 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
9069 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9070 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9071 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9072 continues.
9073
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009074 - set-src <expr> :
9075 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9076 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9077 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9078 set-src"
9079
9080 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9081 followed by some converters.
9082
9083 Example:
9084
9085 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9086
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009087 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9088 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009089
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009090 - set-src-port <expr> :
9091 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9092 expression.
9093
9094 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9095 followed by some converters.
9096
9097 Example:
9098
9099 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9100
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009101 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9102 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9103 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009104
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009105 - set-dst <expr> :
9106 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9107 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9108 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9109 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9110 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9111
9112 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9113 followed by some converters.
9114
9115 Example:
9116
9117 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9118 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9119
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009120 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9121 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9122
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009123 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9124 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9125 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9126 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9127
9128
9129 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9130 followed by some converters.
9131
9132 Example:
9133
9134 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9135
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009136 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9137 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9138 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9139
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009140 - "silent-drop" :
9141 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
9142 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
9143 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9144 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9145 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9146 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9147 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
9148 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
9149 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
9150 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9151 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
9152 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
9153 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9154 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9155 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9156 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9157
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009158 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9159 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9160 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009161
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009162 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9163 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9164 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009165
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009166 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009167 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009168 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009169
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009170 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9171 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9172 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009173
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009174 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009175 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9176 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009177
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009178 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9179
9180 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9181
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009182 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9183
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009184 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009185
9186
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009187tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9188 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009189 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009190 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009191 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009192 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9193 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009194
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009195 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009196
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009197 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
9198 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9199 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9200 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9201 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009202
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009203 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9204 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9205 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9206 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009207 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9208 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9209 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9210 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9211 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9212 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009213 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009214 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009215
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009216 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9217 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9218 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9219 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009220
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009221 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009222 - accept : the request is accepted
9223 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9224 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009225 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009226 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02009227 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009228 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009229 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009230 - silent-drop
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009231
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009232 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9233 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009234
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009235 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9236 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9237 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9238 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9239 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9240 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009241
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009242 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009243 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9244 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009245
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009246 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009247 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9248 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9249 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9250 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009251 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9252 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9253 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009254
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009255 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009256 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9257 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9258 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009259
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009260 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009261 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9262 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009263
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009264 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9265 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009266 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009267 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9268 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009269 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009270 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009271 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009272 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9273 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009274 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009275 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9276 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009277
9278 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9279 followed by some converters.
9280
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009281 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9282 <var-name>.
9283
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009284 Example:
9285
9286 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009287 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009288
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009289 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009290 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9291 # and reject everything else.
9292 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9293 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009294 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009295 tcp-request content reject
9296
9297 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009298 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9299 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9300 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009301 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009302
9303 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9304 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9305 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009306 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009307 tcp-request content reject
9308
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009309 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009310 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009311 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009312 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009313 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
9314 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009315
9316 Example:
9317 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9318 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009319 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009320
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009321 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009322 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009323
9324 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009325 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009326 # protecting all our sites
9327 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009328 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9329 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009330 ...
9331 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9332
9333 backend http_dynamic
9334 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009335 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009336 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009337 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009338 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009339 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009340 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009341
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009342 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009343
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03009344 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
9345 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009346
9347
9348tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9349 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9350 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009351 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009352 Arguments :
9353 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9354 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9355 as explained at the top of this document.
9356
9357 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9358 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9359 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9360 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9361 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9362
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009363 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9364 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9365 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9366 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9367
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009368 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9369 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009370 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009371 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009372 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9373 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9374 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9375 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009376
9377 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9378 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9379 it pass through unaffected.
9380
9381 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9382 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9383 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009384 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009385 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9386 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009387 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9388 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9389 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009390
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009391 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009392 "timeout client".
9393
9394
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009395tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9396 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9397 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9398 no | no | yes | yes
9399 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009400 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9401 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009402
9403 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9404
9405 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
9406 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9407 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009408 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9409 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009410
9411 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9412
9413 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9414 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9415 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9416 inserted.
9417
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009418 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009419 - accept :
9420 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9421 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9422 the rules evaluation.
9423
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009424 - close :
9425 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
9426 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
9427 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
9428 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
9429 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
9430 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009431 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009432 protocols.
9433
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009434 - reject :
9435 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9436 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009437 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009438
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009439 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9440 Sets a variable.
9441
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009442 - unset-var(<var-name>)
9443 Unsets a variable.
9444
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009445 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9446 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9447 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9448 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9449
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009450 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
9451 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9452 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9453 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9454 continues.
9455
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009456 - "silent-drop" :
9457 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
9458 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
9459 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9460 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9461 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9462 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9463 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
9464 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
9465 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
9466 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9467 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
9468 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
9469 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9470 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9471 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9472 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9473
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009474 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9475 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9476 for changing the default action to a reject.
9477
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009478 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
9479 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
9480 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
9481 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009482 period.
9483
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009484 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
9485 declared inline.
9486
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009487 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9488 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009489 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009490 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9491 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009492 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009493 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009494 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009495 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9496 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009497 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009498 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9499 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009500
9501 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9502 followed by some converters.
9503
9504 Example:
9505
9506 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
9507
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009508 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9509 <var-name>.
9510
9511 Example:
9512
9513 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
9514
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009515 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9516
9517 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
9518
9519
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009520tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9521 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
9522 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9523 no | yes | yes | no
9524 Arguments :
9525 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9526 below.
9527
9528 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9529
9530 Once a session is validated, (ie. after all handshakes have been completed),
9531 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
9532 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
9533 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
9534 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
9535 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
9536 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
9537 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
9538 from the PROXY protocol header (eg: track a source forwarded this way). The
9539 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
9540 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
9541 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
9542 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
9543 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
9544 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
9545 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
9546 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
9547 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
9548 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
9549 instead.
9550
9551 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9552 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9553 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
9554 rules which may be inserted.
9555
9556 Several types of actions are supported :
9557 - accept : the request is accepted
9558 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9559 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
9560 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
9561 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
9562 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009563 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009564 - silent-drop
9565
9566 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
9567 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
9568 sections for a complete description.
9569
9570 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9571 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9572 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
9573
9574 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
9575 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
9576 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
9577 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
9578 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
9579
9580 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9581 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9582
9583 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9584 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
9585 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
9586
9587 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9588 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
9589 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9590
9591 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
9592 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9593 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
9594
9595 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9596 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9597 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
9598
9599 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9600
9601 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
9602
9603
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009604tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
9605 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
9606 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9607 no | no | yes | yes
9608 Arguments :
9609 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9610 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9611 as explained at the top of this document.
9612
9613 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
9614
9615
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009616timeout check <timeout>
9617 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
9618 established.
9619
9620 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9621 yes | no | yes | yes
9622 Arguments:
9623 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9624 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9625 as explained at the top of this document.
9626
9627 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
9628 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
9629 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
9630 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01009631 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
9632 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
9633 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009634
9635 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
9636 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
9637
9638 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
9639 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009640 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009641
9642 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9643 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9644 forget about it.
9645
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009646 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
9647 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009648
9649
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009650timeout client <timeout>
9651timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9652 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
9653 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9654 yes | yes | yes | no
9655 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009656 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009657 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9658 as explained at the top of this document.
9659
9660 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9661 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9662 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009663 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
9664 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
9665 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
9666 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009667 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
9668 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
9669 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009670 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009671 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009672 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
9673 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009674 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
9675 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009676
9677 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9678 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9679 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9680 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9681 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9682 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9683
9684 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
9685 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
9686 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9687
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009688 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
9689 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009690
9691
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009692timeout client-fin <timeout>
9693 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
9694 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9695 yes | yes | yes | no
9696 Arguments :
9697 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9698 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9699 as explained at the top of this document.
9700
9701 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9702 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9703 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9704 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9705 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
9706 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9707 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9708 down in one direction.
9709
9710 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9711 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9712 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
9713
9714 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
9715
9716
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009717timeout connect <timeout>
9718timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9719 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
9720 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9721 yes | no | yes | yes
9722 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009723 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009724 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9725 as explained at the top of this document.
9726
9727 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009728 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009729 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009730 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009731 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
9732 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009733
9734 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9735 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9736 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9737 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9738 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
9739 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9740
9741 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
9742 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
9743 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9744
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009745 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
9746 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009747
9748
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009749timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
9750 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
9751 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9752 yes | yes | yes | yes
9753 Arguments :
9754 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9755 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9756 as explained at the top of this document.
9757
9758 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
9759 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
9760 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
9761 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
9762 once the request has started to present itself.
9763
9764 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
9765 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
9766 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
9767 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
9768 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
9769
9770 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
9771 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
9772 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
9773 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
9774
9775 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
9776 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
9777 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
9778 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
9779 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02009780 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009781
9782 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
9783 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
9784 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
9785 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
9786
9787 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
9788
9789
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009790timeout http-request <timeout>
9791 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
9792 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009793 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009794 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009795 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009796 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9797 as explained at the top of this document.
9798
9799 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
9800 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
9801 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
9802 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
9803 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
9804 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
9805 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02009806 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
9807 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
9808 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
9809 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
9810 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009811 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
9812 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009813
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009814 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
9815 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
9816 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
9817 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
9818 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009819 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009820
9821 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
9822 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
9823 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
9824 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
9825 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
9826
9827 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009828 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
9829 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
9830 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009831
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009832 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009833 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009834
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009835
9836timeout queue <timeout>
9837 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
9838 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9839 yes | no | yes | yes
9840 Arguments :
9841 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9842 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9843 as explained at the top of this document.
9844
9845 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
9846 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
9847 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
9848 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
9849 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
9850
9851 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
9852 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
9853 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
9854 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
9855
9856 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9857
9858
9859timeout server <timeout>
9860timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9861 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
9862 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9863 yes | no | yes | yes
9864 Arguments :
9865 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9866 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9867 as explained at the top of this document.
9868
9869 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9870 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9871 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
9872 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
9873 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
9874 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
9875 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
9876
9877 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9878 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9879 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
9880 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
9881 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009882 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009883 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009884 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
9885 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
9886 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
9887 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009888
9889 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9890 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9891 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9892 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9893 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9894 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9895
9896 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
9897 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
9898 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9899
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009900 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009901
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009902
9903timeout server-fin <timeout>
9904 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
9905 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9906 yes | no | yes | yes
9907 Arguments :
9908 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9909 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9910 as explained at the top of this document.
9911
9912 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9913 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9914 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9915 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9916 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
9917 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9918 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9919 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
9920 situations, it should not be needed.
9921
9922 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9923 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9924 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
9925
9926 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
9927
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009928
9929timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009930 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009931 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9932 yes | yes | yes | yes
9933 Arguments :
9934 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
9935 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9936 as explained at the top of this document.
9937
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009938 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit" or
9939 "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with no activity for a certain
9940 amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" defines how long it will
9941 be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009942
9943 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9944 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9945 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
9946 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009947 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009948
9949 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9950
9951
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009952timeout tunnel <timeout>
9953 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
9954 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9955 yes | no | yes | yes
9956 Arguments :
9957 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9958 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9959 as explained at the top of this document.
9960
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009961 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009962 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
9963 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
9964 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
9965 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
9966 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
9967 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
9968 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
9969 specified.
9970
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009971 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
9972 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
9973 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
9974 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
9975 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
9976 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
9977 state.
9978
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009979 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9980 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9981 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
9982 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
9983 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
9984
9985 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9986 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9987 forget about it.
9988
9989 Example :
9990 defaults http
9991 option http-server-close
9992 timeout connect 5s
9993 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009994 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009995 timeout server 30s
9996 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
9997
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009998 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009999
10000
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010001transparent (deprecated)
10002 Enable client-side transparent proxying
10003 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010010004 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010005 Arguments : none
10006
10007 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
10008 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
10009 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10010 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10011 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10012 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10013 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10014 appropriate server.
10015
10016 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10017
10018 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10019 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10020
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010021 See also: "option transparent"
10022
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010023unique-id-format <string>
10024 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10025 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10026 yes | yes | yes | no
10027 Arguments :
10028 <string> is a log-format string.
10029
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010030 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10031 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10032 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10033 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010034
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010035 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10036 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10037 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10038 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10039 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10040 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10041 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10042 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010043
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010044 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10045 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010046
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010047 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010048
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010049 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010050
10051 will generate:
10052
10053 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10054
10055 See also: "unique-id-header"
10056
10057unique-id-header <name>
10058 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10059 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10060 yes | yes | yes | no
10061 Arguments :
10062 <name> is the name of the header.
10063
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010064 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10065 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010066
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010067 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010068
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010069 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010070 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10071
10072 will generate:
10073
10074 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10075
10076 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010077
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010078use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010079 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010080 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10081 no | yes | yes | no
10082 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010083 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10084 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010085
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010086 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10087 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010088
10089 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10090 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10091 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010092 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
10093 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
10094 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10095 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010096
10097 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10098 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10099 assign the backend.
10100
10101 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10102 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10103 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10104 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10105 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10106 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10107
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010108 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010109 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010110 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10111 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10112 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10113
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010114 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10115 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10116 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10117 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10118 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10119 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10120 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10121 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10122 cannot be forced from the request.
10123
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010124 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010125 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10126 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10127
10128 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10129 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010130
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010131
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010132use-server <server> if <condition>
10133use-server <server> unless <condition>
10134 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10135 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10136 no | no | yes | yes
10137 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010138 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010139
10140 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10141
10142 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10143 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10144 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10145
10146 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10147 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10148 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10149 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10150 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10151 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10152 matches will assign the server.
10153
10154 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10155 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10156 with the next rules until one matches.
10157
10158 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10159 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10160 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10161 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10162
10163 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10164 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10165 stripped.
10166
10167 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10168 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10169 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10170 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10171
10172 Example :
10173 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10174 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10175 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10176 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10177 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10178 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000010179 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010180 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10181 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10182
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010183 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010184
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010185
101865. Bind and Server options
10187--------------------------
10188
10189The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10190depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10191settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10192written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10193described in this section.
10194
10195
101965.1. Bind options
10197-----------------
10198
10199The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10200as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10201no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10202parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10203while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10204provided immediately after the setting name.
10205
10206The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10207
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010208accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10209 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10210 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10211 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10212 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10213 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10214 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10215 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10216 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10217 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010218 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10219 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10220 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010221
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010222accept-proxy
10223 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010224 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10225 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010226 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10227 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10228 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10229 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
10230 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
10231 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10232 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010233 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10234 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010235
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010236alpn <protocols>
10237 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10238 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10239 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
10240 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
10241 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
10242 initial NPN extension.
10243
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010244backlog <backlog>
10245 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
10246 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10247
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010248curves <curves>
10249 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10250 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10251 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10252 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10253 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10254 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10255
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010256ecdhe <named curve>
10257 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010258 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10259 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010260
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010261ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010262 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10263 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10264 client's certificate.
10265
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010266ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10267 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10268 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10269 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10270 error is ignored.
10271
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010272ca-sign-file <cafile>
10273 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10274 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10275 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10276 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10277 'generate-certificates' for details.
10278
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010279ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010280 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10281 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10282 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10283 'generate-certificates' for details.
10284
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010285ciphers <ciphers>
10286 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10287 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010288 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010289 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
10290 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
10291
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010292crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010293 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10294 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10295 to verify client's certificate.
10296
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010297crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010298 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10299 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10300 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10301 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10302 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10303 file.
10304
10305 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10306 are loaded.
10307
10308 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010309 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010310 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10311 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10312 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10313 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
10314 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10315 instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
10316 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010317
10318 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10319 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10320 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10321 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010322 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10323 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010324
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010325 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010326
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010327 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
10328 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +080010329 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010330 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
10331 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10332 clients).
10333
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010334 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10335 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10336 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10337 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10338 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10339 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10340 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10341 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10342 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10343 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
10344 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
10345 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
10346 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
10347
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010348 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
10349 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
10350 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
10351 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
10352 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
10353
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010354 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
10355 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
10356 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
10357 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010358
10359 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
10360 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
10361 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
10362 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
10363 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
10364 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
10365 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
10366 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
10367 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
10368
10369 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
10370
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010371 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010372 a cert bundle.
10373
10374 Haproxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
10375 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
10376 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
10377 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
10378 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
10379 provide multi-cert support.
10380
10381 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
10382
10383 Filename | CN | SAN
10384 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10385 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010386 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010387 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
10388 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10389
10390 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
10391 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
10392 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
10393 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010394 suites. With BoringSSL multi-cert is natively supported, no need to bundle
10395 certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010396
10397 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
10398 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
10399
10400 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
10401 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
10402 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
10403
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010404crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010405 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
10406 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010407 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010408 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010409
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010410crt-list <file>
10411 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010412 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
10413 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010414
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010415 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
10416
10417 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca_file", "crl_file", "ecdhe",
Emmanuel Hocdet4608ed92017-01-20 13:06:27 +010010418 "curves", "ciphers" configuration.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010419 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010420
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020010421 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
10422 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
10423 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
10424 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
10425 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
10426 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
10427 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
10428 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010429
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010430 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020010431 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010432 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL multi-cert is natively supported,
10433 avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can be declared in a
10434 row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010435
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010436 crt-list file example:
10437 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010438 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010439 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010440 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010441
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010442defer-accept
10443 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10444 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
10445 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
10446 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
10447 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
10448 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
10449 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
10450 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
10451 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
10452 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
10453 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
10454
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020010455expose-fd listeners
10456 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
10457 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020010458 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
10459 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020010460 See alors "-x" in the management guide.
10461
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010462force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010463 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010464 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010465 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010466 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010467
10468force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010469 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010470 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010471 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010472
10473force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010474 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010475 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010476 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010477
10478force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010479 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010480 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010481 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010482
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010483force-tlsv13
10484 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
10485 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010486 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010487
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010488generate-certificates
10489 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10490 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
10491 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
10492 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
10493 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
10494 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
10495 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
10496 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
10497 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
10498 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
10499 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
10500
10501 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
10502 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
10503 increases the HAProxy's memroy footprint to reduce latency when the same
10504 certificate is used many times.
10505
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010506gid <gid>
10507 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
10508 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10509 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
10510 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
10511 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10512
10513group <group>
10514 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
10515 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
10516 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
10517 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
10518 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10519
10520id <id>
10521 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
10522 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
10523 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
10524 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
10525
10526interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010010527 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
10528 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
10529 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
10530 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
10531 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
10532 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
10533 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010534
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010535level <level>
10536 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
10537 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
10538 sockets. <level> can be one of :
10539 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
10540 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
10541 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
10542 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
10543 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
10544 counters).
10545 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
10546 all counters).
10547
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010548maxconn <maxconn>
10549 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
10550 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
10551 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
10552 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
10553 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
10554 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
10555 eat all memory.
10556
10557mode <mode>
10558 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
10559 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
10560 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
10561 UNIX sockets.
10562
10563mss <maxseg>
10564 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
10565 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
10566 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
10567 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
10568 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
10569 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
10570 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
10571 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
10572 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
10573 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
10574 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
10575
10576name <name>
10577 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
10578 page.
10579
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020010580namespace <name>
10581 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
10582 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
10583 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
10584 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
10585
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010586nice <nice>
10587 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
10588 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
10589 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
10590 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
10591 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
10592 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
10593 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
10594 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
10595 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
10596 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
10597 one for an RDP socket.
10598
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010599no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010600 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010601 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010602 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010603 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010604 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
10605 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010606
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010607no-tls-tickets
10608 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10609 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
10610 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010611 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
10612 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010613
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010614no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010615 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010616 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010617 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010618 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010619 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10620 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010621
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010622no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010623 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010624 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010625 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010626 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010627 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10628 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010629
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010630no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010631 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010632 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010633 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010634 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010635 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10636 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010637
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010638no-tlsv13
10639 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10640 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
10641 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
10642 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010643 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10644 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010645
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010646npn <protocols>
10647 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
10648 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
10649 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10650 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010651 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
10652 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010653
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000010654prefer-client-ciphers
10655 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
10656 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
10657 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
10658
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010659process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
10660 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
10661 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
10662 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
10663 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
10664 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
10665 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
10666 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +020010667 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
10668 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
10669 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
10670 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
10671 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
10672 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
10673 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010674
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010675ssl
10676 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010677 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010678 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
10679 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
10680 to deciphered contents.
10681
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010682ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
10683 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
10684 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10685 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
10686
10687ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
10688 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
10689 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10690 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
10691
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010010692strict-sni
10693 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
10694 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
10695 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
10696 See the "crt" option for more information.
10697
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010698tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010010699 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010700 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
10701 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010010702 receiving an acknowledgement for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010703 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
10704 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
10705 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
10706 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
10707 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
10708 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
10709 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
10710
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010711tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010010712 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010713 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
10714 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
10715 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
10716 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
10717 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
10718 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
10719 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020010720 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
10721 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
10722 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010723
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010010724tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
10725 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
10726 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
10727 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
10728 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
10729 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
10730 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
10731 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
10732 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
10733 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
10734 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
10735
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010736transparent
10737 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10738 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
10739 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
10740 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
10741 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
10742 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
10743 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
10744 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
10745 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
10746 so check for support with your vendor.
10747
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010748v4v6
10749 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10750 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
10751 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
10752 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010753 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010754
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010755v6only
10756 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10757 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
10758 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010759 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
10760 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010761
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010762uid <uid>
10763 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
10764 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10765 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
10766 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
10767 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10768
10769user <user>
10770 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
10771 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10772 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
10773 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
10774 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10775
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010776verify [none|optional|required]
10777 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
10778 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
10779 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
10780 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
10781 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010782 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
10783 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
10784 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
10785 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010786
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200107875.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010010788------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010789
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010790The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
10791which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
10792arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
10793settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
10794after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
10795Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
10796address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010797
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010798 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010799 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010800
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010801Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
10802keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
10803
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010804The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010805
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020010806addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010807 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010010808 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
10809 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
10810 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
10811 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
10812 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010813
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010814agent-check
10815 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010816 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
10817 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
10818 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
10819 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010820
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010821 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010822 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020010823 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
10824 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
10825 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010826
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020010827 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values in
10828 this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
10829 connections advertised needs to be multipled by the number of load balancers
10830 and different backends that use this health check to get the total number
10831 of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
10832
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010833 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10834 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010835
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010836 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10837 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
10838 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010839
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010840 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10841 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
10842 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010843
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010844 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
10845 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
10846 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
10847 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
10848 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
10849 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
10850 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010851
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010852 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
10853 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010854
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010855 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
10856 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
10857 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
10858 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
10859 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
10860 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
10861 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
10862 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
10863 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010864
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010865 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
10866 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010867 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
10868 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
10869 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010010870 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010871
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010872 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010873 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010874
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070010875agent-send <string>
10876 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
10877 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
10878 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
10879 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
10880 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
10881
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010882agent-inter <delay>
10883 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
10884 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
10885
10886 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
10887 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
10888 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
10889 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
10890 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
10891 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
10892 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
10893 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
10894 of backends use the same servers.
10895
10896 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
10897
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010010898agent-addr <addr>
10899 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
10900
10901 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
10902 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
10903 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
10904 hostname, it will be resolved.
10905
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010906agent-port <port>
10907 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
10908
10909 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
10910
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010911backup
10912 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
10913 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
10914 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
10915 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010916 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
10917 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010918
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010919ca-file <cafile>
10920 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10921 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10922 server's certificate.
10923
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010924check
10925 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010010926 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
10927 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
10928 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
10929 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
10930 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
10931 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
10932 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090010933 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
10934 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010935 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
10936 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010937
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020010938check-send-proxy
10939 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
10940 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
10941 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
10942 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
10943 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
10944 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
10945 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
10946
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010947check-ssl
10948 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
10949 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
10950 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
10951 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010952 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010953 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
10954 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
10955 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010956 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
10957 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010958
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010959ciphers <ciphers>
10960 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010961 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010962 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
10963 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
10964 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
10965 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
10966 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
10967 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
10968
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010969cookie <value>
10970 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
10971 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
10972 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
10973 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
10974 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
10975 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
10976 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
10977
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010978crl-file <crlfile>
10979 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10980 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10981 to verify server's certificate.
10982
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020010983crt <cert>
10984 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10985 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
10986 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
10987 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
10988 certificate request.
10989
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020010990disabled
10991 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
10992 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
10993 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
10994 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
10995 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010996 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020010997
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010998enabled
10999 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
11000 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
11001 default value.
11002 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
11003 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020011004
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011005error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010011006 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
11007 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
11008 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011009
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011010 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011011
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011012fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011013 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
11014 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
11015 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
11016
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011017force-sslv3
11018 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11019 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011020 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011021 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011022
11023force-tlsv10
11024 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011025 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011026 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011027
11028force-tlsv11
11029 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011030 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011031 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011032
11033force-tlsv12
11034 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011035 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011036 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011037
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011038force-tlsv13
11039 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11040 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011041 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011042
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011043id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020011044 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
11045 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
11046 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011047
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011048init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
11049 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
11050 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
11051 turn each of the methods mentionned in the comma-delimited list. The first
11052 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
11053 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
11054 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
11055 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
11056 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
11057 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
11058 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
11059 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
11060 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
11061 server (eg: filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
11062 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
11063 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
11064 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
11065 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
11066 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
11067 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
11068 historic behaviour.
11069
11070 Example:
11071 defaults
11072 # never fail on address resolution
11073 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
11074
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011075inter <delay>
11076fastinter <delay>
11077downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011078 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
11079 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11080 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
11081 between checks depending on the server state :
11082
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020011083 Server state | Interval used
11084 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11085 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
11086 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11087 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
11088 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
11089 or yet unchecked. |
11090 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11091 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
11092 | "inter" otherwise.
11093 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011094
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011095 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
11096 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
11097 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
11098 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011099 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11100 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11101 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11102 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11103 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011104
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011105maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011106 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
11107 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
11108 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
11109 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
11110 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
11111 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
11112 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
11113 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
11114
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011115maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011116 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
11117 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
11118 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
11119 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
11120 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
11121 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
11122 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
11123
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011124minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011125 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
11126 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
11127 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
11128 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
11129 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
11130 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011131 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011132 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011133
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011134namespace <name>
11135 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11136 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
11137 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11138 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11139
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011140no-agent-check
11141 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
11142 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11143 default value.
11144 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11145 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
11146
11147no-backup
11148 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
11149 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11150 default value.
11151 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11152 "default-server" "backup" setting.
11153
11154no-check
11155 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
11156 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11157 default value.
11158 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11159 "default-server" "check" setting.
11160
11161no-check-ssl
11162 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
11163 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11164 default value.
11165 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11166 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
11167
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011168no-send-proxy
11169 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
11170 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11171 default value.
11172 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11173 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
11174
11175no-send-proxy-v2
11176 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
11177 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11178 default value.
11179 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11180 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
11181
11182no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
11183 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
11184 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11185 default value.
11186 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11187 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
11188
11189no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11190 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
11191 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11192 default value.
11193 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11194 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
11195
11196no-ssl
11197 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
11198 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11199 default value.
11200 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11201 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
11202
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010011203no-ssl-reuse
11204 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
11205 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
11206 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
11207 and for paranoid users.
11208
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011209no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011210 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11211 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011212 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011213
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011214 Supported in default-server: No
11215
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011216no-tls-tickets
11217 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11218 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11219 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011220 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
11221 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011222 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011223
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011224no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011225 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011226 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11227 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011228 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11229 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011230 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011231
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011232 Supported in default-server: No
11233
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011234no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011235 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011236 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11237 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011238 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11239 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011240 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011241
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011242 Supported in default-server: No
11243
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011244no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011245 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011246 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11247 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011248 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11249 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011250 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011251
11252 Supported in default-server: No
11253
11254no-tlsv13
11255 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11256 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11257 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
11258 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11259 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011260 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011261
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011262 Supported in default-server: No
11263
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011264no-verifyhost
11265 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
11266 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11267 default value.
11268 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11269 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011270
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090011271non-stick
11272 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
11273 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
11274 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
11275
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011276observe <mode>
11277 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
11278 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
11279 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
11280 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
11281 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
11282 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010011283 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011284
11285 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
11286
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011287on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011288 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
11289 Currently, four modes are available:
11290 - fastinter: force fastinter
11291 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
11292 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
11293 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
11294 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
11295
11296 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
11297
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011298on-marked-down <action>
11299 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
11300 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011301 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
11302 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
11303 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
11304 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
11305 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
11306 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
11307 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
11308 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011309
11310 Actions are disabled by default
11311
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011312on-marked-up <action>
11313 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
11314 Currently one action is available:
11315 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
11316 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
11317 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
11318 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
11319 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
11320 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
11321 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
11322 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
11323
11324 Actions are disabled by default
11325
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011326port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011327 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
11328 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
11329 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
11330 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
11331 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
11332 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
11333
11334redir <prefix>
11335 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
11336 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
11337 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
11338 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
11339 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
11340 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
11341 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
11342 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011343 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011344 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
11345 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
11346 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
11347 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
11348 loop between the client and HAProxy!
11349
11350 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
11351
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011352rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011353 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
11354 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
11355 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
11356
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011357resolve-prefer <family>
11358 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
11359 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
11360 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
11361 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
11362
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020011363 Default value: ipv6
11364
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011365 Example:
11366
11367 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011368
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011369resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
11370 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
11371 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011372 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011373 differents datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
11374 this patch permitsto prefers a local datacenter. If none address matchs the
11375 configured network, another address is selected.
11376
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011377 Example:
11378
11379 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011380
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011381resolvers <id>
11382 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
11383 hostname.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011384 In order to be operational, DNS resolution requires that health check is
11385 enabled on the server. Actually, health checks triggers the DNS resolution.
11386 You must precise one 'resolvers' parameter on each server line where DNS
11387 resolution is required.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011388
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011389 Example:
11390
11391 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011392
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011393 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011394
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011395send-proxy
11396 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
11397 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
11398 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
11399 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011400 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
11401 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
11402 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
11403 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
11404 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
11405 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
11406 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
11407 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
11408 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
11409 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011410 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
11411 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011412
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011413send-proxy-v2
11414 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
11415 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11416 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11417 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11418 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011419 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the
11420 "no-send-proxy-v2" option of this section and send-proxy" option of the
11421 "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011422
11423send-proxy-v2-ssl
11424 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11425 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11426 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11427 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11428 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11429 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
11430 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011431 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
11432 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011433
11434send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11435 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11436 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11437 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11438 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11439 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11440 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
11441 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
11442 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011443 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and the
11444 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011445
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011446slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011447 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
11448 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
11449 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
11450 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
11451 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
11452 parameters :
11453
11454 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
11455 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
11456
11457 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
11458 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
11459 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
11460 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
11461
11462 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
11463 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
11464 seen as failed.
11465
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020011466sni <expression>
11467 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
11468 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
11469 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
11470 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
11471 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense.
11472
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011473source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011474source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011475source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011476 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
11477 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
11478 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
11479 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
11480
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011481 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
11482 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
11483 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
11484 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
11485 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
11486 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
11487 server.
11488
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000011489 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
11490 specifying the source address without port(s).
11491
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011492ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020011493 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
11494 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
11495 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
11496 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
11497 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
11498 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011499 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
11500 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011501
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011502ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11503 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
11504 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
11505 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11506
11507ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11508 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
11509 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
11510 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11511
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011512ssl-reuse
11513 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
11514 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11515 default value.
11516 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11517 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
11518
11519stick
11520 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
11521 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11522 default value.
11523 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11524 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011525
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020011526tcp-ut <delay>
11527 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
11528 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
11529 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011530 acknowledgement for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020011531 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
11532 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
11533 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
11534 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
11535 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
11536 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
11537 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
11538 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
11539 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11540
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011541track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020011542 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
11543 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
11544 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
11545 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011546 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
11547
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011548tls-tickets
11549 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
11550 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11551 default value.
11552 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11553 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011554
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011555verify [none|required]
11556 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010011557 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
11558 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
11559 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
11560 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020011561 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
11562 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
11563 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011564
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070011565verifyhost <hostname>
11566 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
11567 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
11568 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
11569 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
11570 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
11571 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011572 See also "no-verifyhost" option.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070011573
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011574weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011575 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
11576 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
11577 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020011578 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
11579 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
11580 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
11581 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
11582 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
11583 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011584
11585
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200115865.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
11587-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011588
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011589HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
11590using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
11591configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011592This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
11593can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
11594workload.
11595This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
11596resolution at run time.
11597Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
11598carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
11599
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011600Bear in mind that DNS resolution is triggered by health checks. This makes
11601health checks mandatory to allow DNS resolution.
11602
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011603
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200116045.3.1. Global overview
11605----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011606
11607As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
11608different steps of the process life:
11609
11610 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
11611 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
11612 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
11613
11614 2. at run time, when HAProxy gets prepared to run a health check on a server,
11615 it verifies if the current name resolution is still considered as valid.
11616 If not, it processes a new resolution, in parallel of the health check.
11617
11618A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
11619 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
11620 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
11621 resolution to know this new IP.
11622
11623A few things important to notice:
11624 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
11625 first valid response.
11626
11627 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
11628 servers return an error.
11629
11630
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200116315.3.2. The resolvers section
11632----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011633
11634This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
11635HAProxy.
11636There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can contain
11637many name servers.
11638
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011639When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
11640uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
11641is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
11642answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
11643
11644When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
11645used by HAProxy to decide what type of behavior to apply.
11646
11647Two types of behavior can be applied:
11648 1. stop DNS resolution
11649 2. replay the DNS query with a new query type
11650 In such case, the following types are applied in this exact order:
11651 1. ANY query type
11652 2. query type corresponding to family pointed by resolve-prefer
11653 server's parameter
11654 3. remaining family type
11655
11656HAProxy stops DNS resolution when the following errors occur:
11657 - invalid DNS response packet
11658 - wrong name in the query section of the response
11659 - NX domain
11660 - Query refused by server
11661 - CNAME not pointing to an IP address
11662
11663HAProxy tries a new query type when the following errors occur:
11664 - no Answer records in the response
11665 - DNS response truncated
11666 - Error in DNS response
11667 - No expected DNS records found in the response
11668 - name server timeout
11669
11670For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section:
11671 - first response is valid and is applied directly, second response is ignored
11672 - first response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
11673 applied;
11674 - first response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
11675 HAProxy replays the query with a new type;
11676 - first response is truncated and second one is a NX Domain, then HAProxy
11677 stops resolution.
11678
11679
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011680resolvers <resolvers id>
11681 Creates a new name server list labelled <resolvers id>
11682
11683A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
11684
11685nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
11686 DNS server description:
11687 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
11688 <ip> : IP address of the server
11689 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
11690
11691hold <status> <period>
11692 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
11693 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011694 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
11695 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011696 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
11697 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11698 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
11699
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011700 Default value is 10s for "valid" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011701
11702 Note: since the name resolution is triggered by the health checks, a new
11703 resolution is triggered after <period> modulo the <inter> parameter of
11704 the healch check.
11705
11706resolve_retries <nb>
11707 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
11708 giving up.
11709 Default value: 3
11710
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011711 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
11712 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
11713 type.
11714
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011715timeout <event> <time>
11716 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
11717 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
11718 events available are:
11719 - retry: time between two DNS queries, when no response have
11720 been received.
11721 Default value: 1s
11722 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11723 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
11724
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011725 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011726
11727 resolvers mydns
11728 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
11729 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
11730 resolve_retries 3
11731 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011732 hold other 30s
11733 hold refused 30s
11734 hold nx 30s
11735 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011736 hold valid 10s
11737
11738
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117396. HTTP header manipulation
11740---------------------------
11741
11742In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
11743response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
11744request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
11745which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011746against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011747
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011748If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
11749to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
11750but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
11751HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
11752stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
11753because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
11754a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
11755still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020011756
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011757This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
11758in section 4.2 :
11759
11760 - reqadd <string>
11761 - reqallow <search>
11762 - reqiallow <search>
11763 - reqdel <search>
11764 - reqidel <search>
11765 - reqdeny <search>
11766 - reqideny <search>
11767 - reqpass <search>
11768 - reqipass <search>
11769 - reqrep <search> <replace>
11770 - reqirep <search> <replace>
11771 - reqtarpit <search>
11772 - reqitarpit <search>
11773 - rspadd <string>
11774 - rspdel <search>
11775 - rspidel <search>
11776 - rspdeny <search>
11777 - rspideny <search>
11778 - rsprep <search> <replace>
11779 - rspirep <search> <replace>
11780
11781With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
11782is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
11783parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
11784prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
11785Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
11786
11787 \t for a tab
11788 \r for a carriage return (CR)
11789 \n for a new line (LF)
11790 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
11791 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
11792 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
11793 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
11794 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
11795
11796The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
11797portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
11798above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
11799regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
118009 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
11801is very common to users of the "sed" program.
11802
11803The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
11804after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
11805
11806Notes related to these keywords :
11807---------------------------------
11808 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
11809 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
11810 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
11811
11812 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
11813 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
11814 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
11815
11816 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
11817 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
11818 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
11819 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
11820 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
11821
11822 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
11823 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
11824 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
11825 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
11826 useless headers before adding new ones.
11827
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011828 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011829 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
11830
11831 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
11832 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
11833 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
11834
11835 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
11836 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011837 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011838
11839
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200118407. Using ACLs and fetching samples
11841----------------------------------
11842
11843Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
11844client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
11845The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
11846these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
11847but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
11848data called patterns.
11849
11850
118517.1. ACL basics
11852---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011853
11854The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
11855content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
11856from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
11857simple :
11858
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011859 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011860 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011861 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
11862 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011863
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011864The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
11865adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011866
11867In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
11868
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011869 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011870
11871This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
11872Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
11873and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011874an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
11875conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
11876as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
11877are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011878
11879ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
11880'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
11881which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
11882
11883There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
11884performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
11885
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011886The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
11887specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
11888this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011889methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
11890ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011891
11892Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
11893 - boolean
11894 - integer (signed or unsigned)
11895 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
11896 - string
11897 - data block
11898
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011899Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
11900converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
11901would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
11902The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
11903which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
11904
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011905Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
11906keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
11907fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
11908which are summarized in the table below :
11909
11910 +---------------------+-----------------+
11911 | Sample or converter | Default |
11912 | output type | matching method |
11913 +---------------------+-----------------+
11914 | boolean | bool |
11915 +---------------------+-----------------+
11916 | integer | int |
11917 +---------------------+-----------------+
11918 | ip | ip |
11919 +---------------------+-----------------+
11920 | string | str |
11921 +---------------------+-----------------+
11922 | binary | none, use "-m" |
11923 +---------------------+-----------------+
11924
11925Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
11926matching method, see below.
11927
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011928The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
11929 - boolean
11930 - integer or integer range
11931 - IP address / network
11932 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
11933 - regular expression
11934 - hex block
11935
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011936The following ACL flags are currently supported :
11937
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011938 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
11939 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011940 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010011941 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010011942 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010011943 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011944 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
11945
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011946The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
11947read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
11948if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
11949lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
11950will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
11951beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
11952a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
11953lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
11954exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
11955
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010011956The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
11957parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
11958ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
11959a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
11960check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
11961
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010011962The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
11963socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
11964file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
11965
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011966Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
11967loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
11968
11969 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
11970
11971In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
11972the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
11973case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
11974as well.
11975
11976The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
11977sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
11978do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
11979methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
11980is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
11981obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
11982followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
11983default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
11984that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
11985string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
11986
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010011987The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
11988By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
11989string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
11990resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
11991server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
11992waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
11993flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
11994function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
11995
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011996There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
11997sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
11998be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011999
12000 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
12001 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012002 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
12003 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
12004 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
12005 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012006
12007 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
12008 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012009 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012010
12011 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012012 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012013
12014 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012015 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012016
12017 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
12018 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
12019
12020 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
12021 binary or string samples.
12022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012023 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
12024 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012025
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012026 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
12027 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
12028 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012029
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012030 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
12031 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012032
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012033 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
12034 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012035
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012036 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
12037 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012038
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012039 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
12040 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012041 This may be used with binary or string samples.
12042
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012043 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
12044 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
12045 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012046
12047For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
12048request, it is possible to do :
12049
12050 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
12051
12052In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
12053buffer, one would use the following acl :
12054
12055 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
12056
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012057On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
12058possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
12059
12060 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
12061
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012062All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
12063criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
12064method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
12065to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
12066criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
12067the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012068
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012069If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012070the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
12071For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012072
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012073 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
12074 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
12075 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
12076 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012077
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012078
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012079The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
12080types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
12081combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
12082brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
12083default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012084
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012085 +-------------------------------------------------+
12086 | Input sample type |
12087 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012088 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012089 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12090 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
12091 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012092 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012093 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012094 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012095 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012096 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012097 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012098 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012099 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012100 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012101 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012102 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012103 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012104 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012105 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012106 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012107 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012108 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012109 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012110 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012111 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012112 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012113 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12114 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
12115 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012116
12117
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200121187.1.1. Matching booleans
12119------------------------
12120
12121In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
12122Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
12123When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
12124that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
12125
12126Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
12127return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
12128"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
12129
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012130
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200121317.1.2. Matching integers
12132------------------------
12133
12134Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
12135enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
12136to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
12137
12138Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
12139matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
12140lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012141
12142For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
12143unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
12144representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
12145
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012146As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
12147two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
12148instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
12149ranges and operators.
12150
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012151For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012152operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
12153Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
12154of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012155
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012156Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012157
12158 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
12159 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
12160 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
12161 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
12162 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
12163
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012164For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012165
12166 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
12167
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012168This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
12169
12170 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
12171
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012172
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200121737.1.3. Matching strings
12174-----------------------
12175
12176String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
12177different forms :
12178
12179 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
12180 patterns ;
12181
12182 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
12183 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
12184
12185 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
12186 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12187
12188 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
12189 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12190
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010012191 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012192 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
12193 matches.
12194
12195 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
12196 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
12197 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012198
12199String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
12200exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
12201characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
12202string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
12203to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012204before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012205
12206
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200122077.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
12208---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012209
12210Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
12211they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
12212possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
12213passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
12214the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012215the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
12216match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012217
12218
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200122197.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
12220-------------------------------------
12221
12222It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
12223not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
12224a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
12225to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
12226digits may be used upper or lower case.
12227
12228Example :
12229 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
12230 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
12231
12232
122337.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
12234---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012235
12236IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
12237netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
12238within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012239host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012240difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
12241at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
12242does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
12243parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012244
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020012245The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
12246abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
12247
12248 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12249 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
12250 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12251 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
12252 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
12253 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
12254 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
12255 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12256
12257Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
12258192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
12259
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012260IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
12261Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
12262trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
12263IPv6 patterns.
12264
12265HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
12266following situations :
12267 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
12268 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
12269 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
12270 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
12271 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
12272 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
12273 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
12274 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
12275 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
12276 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
12277
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012278
122797.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
12280----------------------------------
12281
12282Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
12283combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
12284
12285 - AND (implicit)
12286 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
12287 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012288
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012289A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012290
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012291 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012292
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012293Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
12294indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012295
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012296For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
12297"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
12298requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
12299is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
12300
12301 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012302 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
12303 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
12304 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012305
12306To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
12307and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
12308
12309 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
12310 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
12311 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
12312 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
12313
12314 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
12315 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
12316 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
12317 use_backend www if host_www
12318
12319It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
12320expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
12321be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
12322the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
12323
12324 The following rule :
12325
12326 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012327 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012328
12329 Can also be written that way :
12330
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012331 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012332
12333It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
12334to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
12335simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
12336sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
12337good use is the following :
12338
12339 With named ACLs :
12340
12341 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
12342 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
12343 monitor fail if site_dead
12344
12345 With anonymous ACLs :
12346
12347 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
12348
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012349See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
12350keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012351
12352
123537.3. Fetching samples
12354---------------------
12355
12356Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
12357against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
12358sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
12359ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
12360of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
12361available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
12362
12363This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
12364Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
12365compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
12366deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
12367
12368The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
12369matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
12370method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
12371indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
12372
12373As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
12374when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
12375mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
12376the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
12377ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
12378
12379Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
12380multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
12381when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
12382incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
12383are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
12384is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
12385all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
12386
12387Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
12388 - name
12389 - name(arg1)
12390 - name(arg1,arg2)
12391
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012392
123937.3.1. Converters
12394-----------------
12395
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012396Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
12397of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
12398is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
12399was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
12400has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
12401unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
12402
12403These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
12404sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
12405the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
12406support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012407
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012408A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
12409support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
12410supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
12411(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
12412bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
12413
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012414The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012415
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001241651d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
12417 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
12418 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
12419 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
12420 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
12421 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
12422
12423 Example :
12424 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
12425 # containg values for the three properties requested by using the
12426 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
12427 frontend http-in
12428 bind *:8081
12429 default_backend servers
12430 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
12431 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
12432
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012433add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012434 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012435 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012436 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
12437 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012438 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012439 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12440 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12441 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12442 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12443 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012444 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012445
12446and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012447 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012448 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012449 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
12450 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012451 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012452 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12453 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12454 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12455 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12456 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012457 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012458
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020012459b64dec
12460 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
12461 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
12462
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020012463base64
12464 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
12465 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
12466 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
12467
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012468bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012469 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012470 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
12471 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
12472 presence of a flag).
12473
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010012474bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
12475 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
12476 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012477 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010012478
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012479cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012480 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
12481 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012482
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012483crc32([<avalanche>])
12484 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
12485 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12486 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12487 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12488 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12489 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
12490 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
12491 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
12492 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
12493 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
12494 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type" directive.
12495
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010012496da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012497 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
12498 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
12499 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
12500 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000012501 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012502 configuration language.
12503
12504 Example:
12505 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020012506 bind *:8881
12507 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000012508 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012509
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020012510debug
12511 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
12512 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
12513 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
12514
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012515div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012516 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
12517 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012518 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012519 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12520 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012521 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012522 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12523 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12524 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12525 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12526 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012527 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012528
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012529djb2([<avalanche>])
12530 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
12531 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12532 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12533 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12534 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12535 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12536 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012537 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6" and the
12538 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012539
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012540even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012541 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012542 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
12543
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010012544field(<index>,<delimiters>)
12545 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
12546 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
12547 list of chars.
12548
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012549hex
12550 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
12551 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
12552 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
12553 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010012554
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012555http_date([<offset>])
12556 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12557 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
12558 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
12559 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
12560 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
12561 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012562
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012563in_table(<table>)
12564 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12565 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
12566 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
12567 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
12568 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
12569
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012570ipmask(<mask>)
12571 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
12572 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
12573 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
12574 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
12575
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012576json([<input-code>])
12577 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
12578 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020012579 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012580 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
12581 of errors:
12582 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
12583 bytes, ...)
12584 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
12585 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
12586
12587 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
12588 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
12589 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
12590 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
12591 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
12592 are :
12593 - "ascii" : never fails ;
12594 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
12595 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
12596 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
12597 error ;
12598 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
12599 characters corresponding to the other errors.
12600
12601 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
12602 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
12603
12604 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012605 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020012606 capture request header user-agent len 150
12607 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012608
12609 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
12610 GET / HTTP/1.0
12611 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
12612
12613 Output log:
12614 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
12615
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012616language(<value>[,<default>])
12617 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
12618 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
12619 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
12620 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
12621 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
12622 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
12623 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
12624 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
12625 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
12626 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
12627 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
12628 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012629
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012630 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012631
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012632 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
12633 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012634
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012635 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
12636 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
12637 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
12638 use_backend spanish if es
12639 use_backend french if fr
12640 use_backend english if en
12641 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012642
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012643lower
12644 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
12645 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
12646 type. The result is of type string.
12647
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020012648ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
12649 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12650 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
12651 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
12652 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
12653 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
12654 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
12655
12656 Example :
12657
12658 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
12659 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
12660 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
12661
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012662map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12663map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12664map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12665 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
12666 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
12667 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
12668 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
12669 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
12670 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
12671 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
12672 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012673
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012674 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
12675 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
12676 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012677
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012678 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012679 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012680
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012681 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
12682 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12683 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
12684 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020012685 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
12686 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012687 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
12688 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12689 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
12690 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12691 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
12692 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12693 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
12694 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080012695 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
12696 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12697 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012698 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12699 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
12700 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12701 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
12702 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012703
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010012704 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
12705 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
12706 the corresponding match text.
12707
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012708 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
12709 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
12710 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
12711 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
12712 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012713
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012714 Example :
12715
12716 # this is a comment and is ignored
12717 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
12718 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
12719 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
12720 | | | `---------- value
12721 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
12722 | `---------------------------- key
12723 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
12724
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012725mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012726 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
12727 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012728 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012729 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012730 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012731 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12732 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12733 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12734 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12735 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012736 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012737
12738mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012739 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020012740 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
12741 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012742 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012743 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012744 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012745 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12746 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12747 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12748 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12749 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012750 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012751
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010012752nbsrv
12753 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
12754 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
12755 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
12756 map lookup.
12757
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012758neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012759 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
12760 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
12761 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
12762 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012763
12764not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012765 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012766 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
12767 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
12768 absence of a flag).
12769
12770odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012771 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012772 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
12773
12774or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012775 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012776 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012777 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
12778 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012779 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012780 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12781 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12782 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12783 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12784 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012785 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012786
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010012787regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012788 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
12789 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
12790 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
12791 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
12792 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
12793 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
12794 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
12795 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
12796 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
12797 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010012798 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
12799 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
12800 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
12801 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012802
12803 Example :
12804
12805 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
12806 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
12807 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
12808 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
12809
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012810capture-req(<id>)
12811 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
12812 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12813
12814 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020012815 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
12816 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012817
12818capture-res(<id>)
12819 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
12820 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12821
12822 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020012823 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
12824 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012825
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012826sdbm([<avalanche>])
12827 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
12828 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12829 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12830 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12831 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12832 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12833 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012834 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6" and the
12835 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012836
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012837set-var(<var name>)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012838 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output as
12839 is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of the
12840 variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012841 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012842 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12843 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012844 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012845 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12846 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012847 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012848 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012849
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012850sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012851 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
12852 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012853 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012854 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12855 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012856 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012857 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12858 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012859 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012860 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12861 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012862 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012863 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012864
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012865table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
12866 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12867 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12868 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
12869 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
12870 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
12871 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
12872
12873
12874table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
12875 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12876 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12877 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
12878 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
12879 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
12880 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
12881
12882table_conn_cnt(<table>)
12883 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12884 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12885 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
12886 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
12887 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12888
12889table_conn_cur(<table>)
12890 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12891 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12892 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
12893 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
12894 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
12895
12896table_conn_rate(<table>)
12897 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12898 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12899 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
12900 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
12901 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
12902
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012903table_gpt0(<table>)
12904 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12905 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
12906 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
12907 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
12908 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
12909
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012910table_gpc0(<table>)
12911 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12912 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12913 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
12914 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
12915 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
12916
12917table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
12918 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12919 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12920 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
12921 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
12922 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
12923 sample fetch keyword.
12924
12925table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
12926 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12927 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12928 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
12929 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
12930 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12931
12932table_http_err_rate(<table>)
12933 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12934 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12935 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
12936 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
12937 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
12938 keyword.
12939
12940table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
12941 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12942 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12943 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
12944 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
12945 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12946
12947table_http_req_rate(<table>)
12948 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12949 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12950 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
12951 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
12952 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
12953 keyword.
12954
12955table_kbytes_in(<table>)
12956 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12957 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12958 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
12959 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
12960 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
12961 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
12962 keyword.
12963
12964table_kbytes_out(<table>)
12965 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12966 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12967 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
12968 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
12969 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
12970 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
12971 keyword.
12972
12973table_server_id(<table>)
12974 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12975 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12976 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
12977 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
12978 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
12979 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
12980
12981table_sess_cnt(<table>)
12982 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12983 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12984 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
12985 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
12986 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
12987 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
12988 keyword.
12989
12990table_sess_rate(<table>)
12991 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12992 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12993 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
12994 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
12995 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
12996 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
12997 keyword.
12998
12999table_trackers(<table>)
13000 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
13001 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
13002 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
13003 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
13004 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
13005 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
13006 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
13007 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
13008 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
13009 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
13010
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013011upper
13012 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
13013 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13014 type. The result is of type string.
13015
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020013016url_dec
13017 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
13018 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
13019
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013020unset-var(<var name>)
13021 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
13022 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
13023 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
13024 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13025 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
13026 response),
13027 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13028 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
13029 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
13030 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
13031
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013032utime(<format>[,<offset>])
13033 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13034 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
13035 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13036 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13037 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13038 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
13039
13040 Example :
13041
13042 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
13043 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
13044 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13045
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010013046word(<index>,<delimiters>)
13047 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
13048 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
13049
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013050wt6([<avalanche>])
13051 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
13052 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13053 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13054 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13055 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13056 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13057 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013058 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", and the
13059 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013060
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013061xor(<value>)
13062 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013063 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013064 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013065 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013066 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013067 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13068 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013069 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013070 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13071 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013072 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013073 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013074
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010013075xxh32([<seed>])
13076 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
13077 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13078 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13079 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13080 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13081 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13082 as cryptographically secure.
13083
13084xxh64([<seed>])
13085 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
13086 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13087 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13088 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13089 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13090 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13091 as cryptographically secure.
13092
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013093
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200130947.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013095--------------------------------------------
13096
13097A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
13098not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
13099"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
13100The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
13101
13102always_false : boolean
13103 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
13104 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
13105
13106always_true : boolean
13107 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
13108 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
13109
13110avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013111 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013112 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
13113 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
13114 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
13115 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
13116 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
13117 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
13118 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
13119 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
13120 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
13121 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
13122 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
13123 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
13124 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010013125
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013126be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013127 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
13128 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
13129 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
13130 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
13131 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013132
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013133be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
13134 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13135 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
13136 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
13137 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
13138 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
13139 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013140
13141 Example :
13142 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
13143 backend dynamic
13144 mode http
13145 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
13146 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013147
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013148bin(<hexa>) : bin
13149 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
13150 of the string.
13151
13152bool(<bool>) : bool
13153 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
13154 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
13155
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013156connslots([<backend>]) : integer
13157 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013158 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013159 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
13160 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050013161
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013162 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013163 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013164 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
13165
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013166 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
13167 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013168
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013169 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013170 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013171 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013172 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
13173 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013174 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013175 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013176
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013177 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
13178 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013179 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013180 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013181
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020013182date([<offset>]) : integer
13183 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
13184 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
13185 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
13186 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020013187 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
13188
13189 Example :
13190
13191 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
13192 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020013193
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020013194env(<name>) : string
13195 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
13196 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
13197 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
13198 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
13199 certain way.
13200
13201 Examples :
13202 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
13203 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
13204
13205 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
13206 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
13207
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013208fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
13209 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013210 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
13211 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013212 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
13213 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
13214 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
13215 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
13216 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013217
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020013218fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
13219 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
13220 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
13221 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
13222
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013223fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
13224 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13225 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
13226 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
13227 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
13228 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
13229 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
13230 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
13231 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013232
13233 Example :
13234 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
13235 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
13236 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
13237 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
13238 frontend mail
13239 bind :25
13240 mode tcp
13241 maxconn 100
13242 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
13243 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
13244 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
13245 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013246
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010013247hostname : string
13248 Returns the system hostname.
13249
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013250int(<integer>) : signed integer
13251 Returns a signed integer.
13252
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013253ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
13254 Returns an ipv4.
13255
13256ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
13257 Returns an ipv6.
13258
13259meth(<method>) : method
13260 Returns a method.
13261
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013262nbproc : integer
13263 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
13264 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
13265 and debugging purposes.
13266
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013267nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
13268 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
13269 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
13270 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013271 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
13272 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
13273 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013274
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013275proc : integer
13276 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
13277 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
13278 debugging purposes.
13279
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013280queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013281 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
13282 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
13283 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013284 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
13285 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
13286 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
13287 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
13288 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
13289
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010013290rand([<range>]) : integer
13291 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
13292 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
13293 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
13294 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
13295 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
13296
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013297srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13298 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
13299 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
13300 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
13301 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
13302 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
13303 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
13304 methods.
13305
13306srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
13307 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
13308 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
13309 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
13310 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
13311 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
13312 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
13313 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
13314
13315srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13316 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13317 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013318 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013319 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
13320 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
13321 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
13322 overloading servers).
13323
13324 Example :
13325 # Redirect to a separate back
13326 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
13327 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
13328 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
13329
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013330stopping : boolean
13331 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
13332 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
13333 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
13334
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013335str(<string>) : string
13336 Returns a string.
13337
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013338table_avl([<table>]) : integer
13339 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
13340 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
13341
13342table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13343 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
13344 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
13345 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
13346
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013347var(<var-name>) : undefined
13348 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013349 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
13350 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013351 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013352 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13353 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013354 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013355 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13356 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013357 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013358 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013359
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200133607.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013361----------------------------------
13362
13363The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
13364closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
13365methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
13366sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
13367TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013368the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
13369counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
13370"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013371argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
13372the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
13373this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013374
13375be_id : integer
13376 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
13377 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
13378
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010013379be_name : string
13380 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
13381 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
13382
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013383dst : ip
13384 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
13385 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
13386 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
13387 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
13388 RFC 4291.
13389
13390dst_conn : integer
13391 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
13392 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
13393 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
13394 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
13395 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
13396 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
13397 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
13398 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013399
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020013400dst_is_local : boolean
13401 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
13402 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
13403 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
13404 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
13405 targetting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
13406 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
13407 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
13408 it only once per connection.
13409
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013410dst_port : integer
13411 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
13412 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
13413 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
13414 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
13415 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
13416 an HTTP header.
13417
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010013418fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
13419 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
13420 header.
13421
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020013422fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
13423 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
13424 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
13425 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
13426 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
13427 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
13428 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13429
13430fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
13431 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
13432 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
13433 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
13434 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
13435 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
13436 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13437
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070013438fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
13439 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
13440 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
13441 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
13442 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13443
13444fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
13445 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
13446 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
13447 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
13448 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13449
13450fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
13451 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
13452 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13453 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13454 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13455
13456fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
13457 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
13458 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13459 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13460 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13461
13462fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
13463 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
13464 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13465 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13466 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13467
13468fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
13469 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
13470 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13471 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13472 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13473
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013474fe_id : integer
13475 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010013476 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013477 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
13478
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010013479fe_name : string
13480 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
13481 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
13482 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
13483
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013484sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013485sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13486sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13487sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013488 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
13489 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
13490 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
13491
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013492sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013493sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13494sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13495sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013496 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
13497 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
13498 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
13499
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013500sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013501sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13502sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13503sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013504 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
13505 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013506 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
13507 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
13508 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013509
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013510 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013511 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
13512 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013513 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
13514 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
13515 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013516 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
13517 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13518
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013519sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013520sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13521sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13522sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013523 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
13524 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
13525
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013526sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013527sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
13528sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
13529sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013530 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
13531 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
13532 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
13533
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013534sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013535sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13536sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13537sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013538 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
13539 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
13540 See also src_conn_rate.
13541
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013542sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013543sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13544sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13545sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013546 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013547 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013548
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013549sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
13550sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13551sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13552sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13553 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
13554 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
13555
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013556sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013557sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
13558sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
13559sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013560 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
13561 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
13562 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013563 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
13564 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
13565 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013566
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013567sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013568sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13569sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13570sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013571 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
13572 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
13573 See also src_http_err_cnt.
13574
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013575sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013576sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13577sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13578sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013579 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
13580 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
13581 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
13582 src_http_err_rate.
13583
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013584sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013585sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13586sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13587sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013588 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
13589 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
13590 src_http_req_cnt.
13591
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013592sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013593sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13594sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13595sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013596 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
13597 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
13598 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
13599 src_http_req_rate.
13600
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013601sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013602sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13603sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13604sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013605 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013606 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
13607 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
13608 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
13609 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013610
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013611 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013612 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
13613 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013614 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13615
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013616sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013617sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
13618sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
13619sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013620 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
13621 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
13622 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013623
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013624sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013625sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
13626sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
13627sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013628 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
13629 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
13630 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013631
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013632sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013633sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13634sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13635sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013636 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
13637 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
13638 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
13639 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013640 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013641 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
13642
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013643sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013644sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13645sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13646sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013647 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
13648 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
13649 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
13650 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
13651 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013652 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013653
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013654sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013655sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
13656sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
13657sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020013658 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
13659 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
13660 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
13661
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013662sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013663sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
13664sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
13665sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013666 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
13667 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013668 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013669 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
13670 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013671 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
13672 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
13673 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013675so_id : integer
13676 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
13677 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
13678 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013679
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013680src : ip
13681 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
13682 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
13683 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
13684 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013685 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
13686 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
13687 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
13688 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013689
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013690 Example:
13691 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
13692 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
13693
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013694src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13695 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
13696 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
13697 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013698 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013699
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013700src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13701 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
13702 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013703 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013704 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013705
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013706src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13707 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
13708 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13709 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
13710 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
13711 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
13712 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013713
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013714 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013715 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
13716 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
13717 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
13718 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013719 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013720 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
13721 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13722
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013723src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013724 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013725 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013726 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013727 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013728
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013729src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013730 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013731 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
13732 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013733 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013734
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013735src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13736 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
13737 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13738 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013739 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013740
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013741src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013742 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013743 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013744 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013745 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013746
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013747src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13748 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
13749 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
13750 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
13751 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
13752
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013753src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013754 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013755 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013756 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
13757 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013758 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
13759 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
13760 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013761
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013762src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13763 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
13764 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013765 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013766 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013767 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013768
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013769src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13770 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
13771 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13772 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
13773 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013774 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013775
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013776src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13777 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
13778 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
13779 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013780 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013781
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013782src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13783 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
13784 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
13785 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013786 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013787 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013788
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013789src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13790 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
13791 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13792 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013793 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013794 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
13795 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013796
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013797 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013798 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013799 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013800 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013801
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020013802src_is_local : boolean
13803 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
13804 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
13805 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
13806 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
13807 client comes from (eg: require auth or https for remote machines). Please
13808 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
13809 once per connection.
13810
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013811src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013812 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
13813 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
13814 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
13815 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
13816 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013817
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013818src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013819 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
13820 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13821 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
13822 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
13823 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013824
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013825src_port : integer
13826 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
13827 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
13828 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
13829 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013830
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013831src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13832 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013833 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13834 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
13835 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013836 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013837
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013838src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13839 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
13840 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13841 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
13842 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013843 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013844
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013845src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13846 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
13847 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
13848 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
13849 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
13850 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
13851 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
13852 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
13853 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013854
13855 Example :
13856 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
13857 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
13858 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
13859 listen ssh
13860 bind :22
13861 mode tcp
13862 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013863 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013864 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013865 server local 127.0.0.1:22
13866
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013867srv_id : integer
13868 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
13869 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
13870 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020013871
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200138727.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013873----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020013874
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013875The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
13876closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
13877when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
13878usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013879future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020013880
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001388151d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
13882 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13883 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13884 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
13885 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13886 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13887
13888 Example :
13889 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
13890 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
13891 # the request.
13892 frontend http-in
13893 bind *:8081
13894 default_backend servers
13895 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13896 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13897
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013898ssl_bc : boolean
13899 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
13900 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
13901 other a server with the "ssl" option.
13902
13903ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
13904 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
13905 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13906
13907ssl_bc_cipher : string
13908 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
13909 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13910
13911ssl_bc_protocol : string
13912 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
13913 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13914
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013915ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013916 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013917 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
13918 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013919
13920ssl_bc_session_id : binary
13921 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
13922 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
13923 if session was reused or not.
13924
13925ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
13926 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
13927 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13928
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013929ssl_c_ca_err : integer
13930 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13931 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
13932 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
13933 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
13934 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020013935
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013936ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
13937 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13938 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
13939 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
13940 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013941
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010013942ssl_c_der : binary
13943 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
13944 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13945 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
13946
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013947ssl_c_err : integer
13948 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13949 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
13950 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
13951 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
13952 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013953
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013954ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13955 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13956 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
13957 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13958 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13959 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13960 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13961 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13962 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013963
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013964ssl_c_key_alg : string
13965 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
13966 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13967 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013968
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013969ssl_c_notafter : string
13970 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
13971 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13972 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020013973
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013974ssl_c_notbefore : string
13975 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
13976 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13977 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010013978
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013979ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13980 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13981 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
13982 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13983 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13984 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13985 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13986 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13987 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010013988
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013989ssl_c_serial : binary
13990 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
13991 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13992 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013993
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013994ssl_c_sha1 : binary
13995 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
13996 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
13997 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020013998 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
13999 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
14000
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014001 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020014002 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014003
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014004ssl_c_sig_alg : string
14005 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
14006 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
14007 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014008
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014009ssl_c_used : boolean
14010 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
14011 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020014012
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014013ssl_c_verify : integer
14014 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
14015 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
14016 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
14017 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020014018
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014019ssl_c_version : integer
14020 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
14021 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020014022
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010014023ssl_f_der : binary
14024 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
14025 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14026 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
14027
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014028ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14029 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14030 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
14031 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14032 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014033 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014034 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14035 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14036 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014037
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014038ssl_f_key_alg : string
14039 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
14040 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
14041 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020014042
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014043ssl_f_notafter : string
14044 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
14045 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14046 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014047
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014048ssl_f_notbefore : string
14049 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
14050 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14051 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014052
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014053ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14054 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14055 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
14056 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14057 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
14058 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
14059 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14060 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14061 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020014062
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014063ssl_f_serial : binary
14064 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
14065 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14066 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014067
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020014068ssl_f_sha1 : binary
14069 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
14070 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
14071 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
14072
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014073ssl_f_sig_alg : string
14074 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
14075 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
14076 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020014077
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014078ssl_f_version : integer
14079 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
14080 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14081
14082ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014083 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
14084 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
14085 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
14086
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014087 Example :
14088 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
14089 listen http-https
14090 bind :80
14091 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
14092 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
14093
14094ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
14095 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
14096 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14097
14098ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014099 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014100 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
14101 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
14102 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
14103 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
14104 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
14105 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
14106 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
14107 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
14108
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014109ssl_fc_cipher : string
14110 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
14111 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014112
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014113ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
14114 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
14115 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014116 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014117
14118ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
14119 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
14120 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014121 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014122
14123ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
14124 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
14125 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
14126 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
14127 avaible with OpenSSL > 1.0.2 compiled with the option enable-ssl-trace.
14128 If the function is not enabled, this sample-fetch returns the hash
14129 like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
14130
14131ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
14132 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
14133 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014134 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014135
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014136ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014137 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
14138 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010014139 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
14140 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
14141 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
14142 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014143
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014144ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
14145 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020014146 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
14147 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
14148 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
14149 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014150
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020014151ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020014152 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
14153 SSL session cache or TLS tickets.
14154
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014155ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014156 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014157 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
14158 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
14159 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
14160 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
14161 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
14162 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
14163 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020014164
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014165ssl_fc_protocol : string
14166 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
14167 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014168
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014169ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040014170 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014171 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
14172 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040014173
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014174ssl_fc_session_id : binary
14175 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
14176 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
14177 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
14178 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014179
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014180ssl_fc_sni : string
14181 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
14182 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
14183 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
14184 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
14185 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
14186
14187 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
14188 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
14189 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020014190 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
14191 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014192
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014193 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014194 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
14195 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020014196
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014197ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
14198 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
14199 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014200
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014201
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200142027.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014203------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014204
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014205Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
14206sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
14207only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
14208For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
14209be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
14210can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
14211sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
14212for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
14213content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014214
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014215payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
14216 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
14217 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
14218 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014219
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014220payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
14221 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
14222 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
14223 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014224
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020014225req.hdrs : string
14226 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
14227 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
14228 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
14229 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
14230
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020014231req.hdrs_bin : binary
14232 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
14233 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
14234 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
14235 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
14236 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
14237 names and values (length of 0 for both).
14238
14239 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
14240
14241 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
14242 str: <int:length><bytes>
14243
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014244req.len : integer
14245req_len : integer (deprecated)
14246 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
14247 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
14248 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
14249 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
14250 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
14251 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
14252 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
14253 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014254
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014255req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
14256 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020014257 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
14258 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
14259 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
14260 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014261
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014262 ACL alternatives :
14263 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014264
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014265req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
14266 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
14267 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
14268 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
14269 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014270
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014271 ACL alternatives :
14272 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014273
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014274 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014275
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014276req.proto_http : boolean
14277req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
14278 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
14279 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
14280 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
14281 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
14282 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
14283 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
14284 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014285
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014286 Example:
14287 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
14288 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
14289 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014290 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014291
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014292req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
14293rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14294 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
14295 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
14296 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
14297 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
14298 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
14299 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
14300 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014301
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014302 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
14303 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
14304 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
14305 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
14306 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
14307 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014308
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014309 ACL derivatives :
14310 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014311
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014312 Example :
14313 listen tse-farm
14314 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
14315 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
14316 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
14317 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
14318 # apply RDP cookie persistence
14319 persist rdp-cookie
14320 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
14321 # This is only useful makes sense if
14322 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
14323 stick-table type string size 204800
14324 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
14325 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
14326 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014327
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014328 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
14329 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014331req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
14332rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
14333 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
14334 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
14335 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
14336 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014337
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014338 ACL derivatives :
14339 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014340
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020014341req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
14342 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
14343 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020014344 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
14345 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
14346 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
14347 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
14348 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020014349
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014350req.ssl_hello_type : integer
14351req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
14352 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
14353 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
14354 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
14355 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
14356 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
14357 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
14358 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014359
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014360req.ssl_sni : string
14361req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
14362 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
14363 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
14364 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
14365 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
14366 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
14367 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
14368 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
14369 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
14370 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
14371 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
14372 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
14373 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014374
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014375 ACL derivatives :
14376 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014377
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014378 Examples :
14379 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
14380 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
14381 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
14382 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
14383 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014384
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053014385req.ssl_st_ext : integer
14386 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
14387 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
14388 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
14389 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
14390 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
14391 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
14392 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
14393 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
14394 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
14395
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014396req.ssl_ver : integer
14397req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
14398 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
14399 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
14400 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
14401 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
14402 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
14403 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
14404 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
14405 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
14406 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014407
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014408 ACL derivatives :
14409 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014410
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020014411res.len : integer
14412 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
14413 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
14414 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
14415 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
14416 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
14417 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
14418 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
14419 content inspection.
14420
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014421res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
14422 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020014423 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
14424 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
14425 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
14426 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014427
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014428res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
14429 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
14430 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
14431 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
14432 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014433
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014434 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014435
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020014436res.ssl_hello_type : integer
14437rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
14438 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
14439 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
14440 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
14441 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
14442 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
14443 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
14444 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
14445
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014446wait_end : boolean
14447 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
14448 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
14449 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
14450 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
14451 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
14452 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
14453 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
14454 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014455
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014456 Examples :
14457 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
14458 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
14459 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014460
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014461 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
14462 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
14463 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
14464 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
14465 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
14466 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
14467 tcp-request content reject
14468
14469
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200144707.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014471--------------------------------------
14472
14473It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
14474This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
14475data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
14476its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
14477HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
14478content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
14479to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
14480more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
14481response are indexed.
14482
14483base : string
14484 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
14485 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
14486 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
14487 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
14488 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
14489 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
14490 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
14491 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
14492
14493 ACL derivatives :
14494 base : exact string match
14495 base_beg : prefix match
14496 base_dir : subdir match
14497 base_dom : domain match
14498 base_end : suffix match
14499 base_len : length match
14500 base_reg : regex match
14501 base_sub : substring match
14502
14503base32 : integer
14504 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
14505 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
14506 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014507 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
14508 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
14509 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014510
14511base32+src : binary
14512 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
14513 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
14514 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
14515 per-URL counters.
14516
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010014517capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
14518 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
14519 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
14520 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
14521
14522capture.req.method : string
14523 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
14524 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
14525 because it's allocated.
14526
14527capture.req.uri : string
14528 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
14529 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
14530 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
14531 allocated.
14532
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020014533capture.req.ver : string
14534 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
14535 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
14536 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
14537
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010014538capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
14539 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
14540 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
14541 The first entry is an index of 0.
14542 See also: "capture response header"
14543
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020014544capture.res.ver : string
14545 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
14546 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
14547 persistent flag.
14548
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020014549req.body : binary
14550 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
14551 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
14552 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
14553 the first chunk is analyzed.
14554
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020014555req.body_param([<name>) : string
14556 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
14557 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
14558 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
14559 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
14560 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
14561 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
14562 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
14563 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
14564 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
14565 given.
14566
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020014567req.body_len : integer
14568 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
14569 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
14570 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
14571 "option http-buffer-request".
14572
14573req.body_size : integer
14574 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
14575 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
14576 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
14577 that the request body has been buffered made available using
14578 "option http-buffer-request".
14579
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014580req.cook([<name>]) : string
14581cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14582 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14583 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
14584 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
14585 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
14586 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
14587 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
14588 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
14589 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
14590
14591 ACL derivatives :
14592 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
14593 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
14594 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
14595 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
14596 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
14597 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
14598 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
14599 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014600
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014601req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14602cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14603 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
14604 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014605
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014606req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
14607cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14608 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14609 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
14610 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
14611 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014612
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014613cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14614 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14615 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
14616 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
14617 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020014618 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014619 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
14620 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
14621 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
14622 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014623
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014624hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14625 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
14626 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
14627 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
14628 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014629 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014630
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014631req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
14632 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
14633 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
14634 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14635 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14636 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14637 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
14638 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
14639 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014640
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014641req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14642 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
14643 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14644 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
14645 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014646
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014647req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14648 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
14649 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
14650 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14651 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14652 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14653 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
14654 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
14655 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000014656 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014657 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
14658 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014659
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014660 ACL derivatives :
14661 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
14662 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
14663 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
14664 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
14665 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
14666 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
14667 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
14668 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
14669
14670req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14671hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
14672 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
14673 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
14674 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
14675 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
14676 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
14677 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
14678 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
14679 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
14680 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
14681
14682req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
14683hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
14684 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
14685 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
14686 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
14687 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
14688 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
14689 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
14690 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
14691 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
14692
14693req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
14694hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
14695 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
14696 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
14697 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
14698 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14699 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14700 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14701 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
14702
14703http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
14704 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
14705 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
14706 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
14707 basic auth is supported.
14708
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010014709http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
14710 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
14711 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
14712 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
14713 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014714 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
14715 basic auth is supported.
14716
14717 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010014718 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
14719 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
14720 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
14721 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014722
14723http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020014724 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
14725 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014726 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
14727 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020014728
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014729method : integer + string
14730 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
14731 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
14732 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
14733 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
14734 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
14735 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
14736 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014737
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014738 ACL derivatives :
14739 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014740
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014741 Example :
14742 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
14743 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
14744 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014745
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014746path : string
14747 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
14748 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
14749 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
14750 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
14751 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
14752 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
14753 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014754
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014755 ACL derivatives :
14756 path : exact string match
14757 path_beg : prefix match
14758 path_dir : subdir match
14759 path_dom : domain match
14760 path_end : suffix match
14761 path_len : length match
14762 path_reg : regex match
14763 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014764
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010014765query : string
14766 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
14767 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
14768 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
14769 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014770 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010014771 which stops before the question mark.
14772
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010014773req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
14774 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
14775 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
14776 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
14777 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
14778
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014779req.ver : string
14780req_ver : string (deprecated)
14781 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
14782 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
14783 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014784
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014785 ACL derivatives :
14786 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014787
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014788res.comp : boolean
14789 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
14790 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
14791 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014792
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014793res.comp_algo : string
14794 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
14795 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
14796 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014797
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014798res.cook([<name>]) : string
14799scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14800 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14801 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
14802 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020014803
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014804 ACL derivatives :
14805 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020014806
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014807res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14808scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14809 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
14810 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
14811 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014812
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014813res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
14814scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14815 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14816 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
14817 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014818
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014819res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14820 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
14821 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
14822 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
14823 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
14824 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
14825 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
14826 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
14827 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
14828 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014830res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14831 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
14832 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14833 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
14834 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
14835 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014836
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014837res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14838shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
14839 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
14840 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
14841 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
14842 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
14843 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
14844 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
14845 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
14846 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014847
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014848 ACL derivatives :
14849 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
14850 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
14851 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
14852 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
14853 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
14854 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
14855 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
14856 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
14857
14858res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14859shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14860 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
14861 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14862 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
14863 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
14864 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014865
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014866res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
14867shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
14868 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
14869 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
14870 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
14871 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
14872 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
14873 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014874
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010014875res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
14876 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
14877 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
14878 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
14879 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
14880
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014881res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
14882shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
14883 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
14884 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
14885 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
14886 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
14887 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
14888 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010014889
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014890res.ver : string
14891resp_ver : string (deprecated)
14892 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
14893 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014894
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014895 ACL derivatives :
14896 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010014897
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014898set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14899 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14900 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020014901 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014902 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010014903
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014904 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
14905 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010014906
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014907status : integer
14908 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
14909 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
14910 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014911
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020014912unique-id : string
14913 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
14914 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
14915 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
14916 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
14917 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
14918 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
14919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014920url : string
14921 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
14922 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
14923 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
14924 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
14925 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
14926 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
14927 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014928
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014929 ACL derivatives :
14930 url : exact string match
14931 url_beg : prefix match
14932 url_dir : subdir match
14933 url_dom : domain match
14934 url_end : suffix match
14935 url_len : length match
14936 url_reg : regex match
14937 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014938
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014939url_ip : ip
14940 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
14941 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
14942 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
14943 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
14944 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
14945 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
14946 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014947
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014948url_port : integer
14949 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
14950 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
14951 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
14952 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014953
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014954urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
14955url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014956 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
14957 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014958 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
14959 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
14960 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
14961 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014962 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
14963 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014964 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
14965 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014966
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014967 ACL derivatives :
14968 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
14969 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
14970 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
14971 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
14972 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
14973 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
14974 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
14975 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014976
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014977
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014978 Example :
14979 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
14980 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
14981 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
14982 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014983
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014984urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014985 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
14986 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
14987 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020014988
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020014989url32 : integer
14990 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
14991 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
14992 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
14993 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
14994 is an unsigned integer.
14995
14996url32+src : binary
14997 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
14998 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
14999 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
15000
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010015001
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200150027.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015003---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010015004
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015005Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
15006every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020015007order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010015008
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015009ACL name Equivalent to Usage
15010---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015011FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020015012HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015013HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
15014HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015015HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
15016HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
15017HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
15018HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
15019LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015020METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020015021METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015022METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
15023METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
15024METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
15025METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020015026METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015027METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015028RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015029REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015030TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015031WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
15032---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010015033
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010015034
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150358. Logging
15036----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010015037
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015038One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
15039provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
15040very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
15041provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
15042state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015043to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015044headers.
15045
15046In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
15047about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
15048send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
15049
15050 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
15051 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
15052 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
15053 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
15054 at the termination.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060015055 - per-request control of log-level, eg:
15056 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015057
15058The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
15059allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
15060as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
15061while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
15062real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
15063delay.
15064
15065
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150668.1. Log levels
15067---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015068
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090015069TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015070source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090015071HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
15072in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
15073track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
15074syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
15075about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015076
15077
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150788.2. Log formats
15079----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015080
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015081HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090015082and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
15083slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
15084options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015085
15086 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
15087 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
15088 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
15089 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
15090 extents.
15091
15092 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
15093 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
15094 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
15095 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
15096 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
15097
15098 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
15099 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
15100 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
15101 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
15102 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
15103
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020015104 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
15105 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
15106 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
15107 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
15108
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015109 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
15110
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015111Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
15112specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
15113field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
15114servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
15115always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
15116identifier.
15117
15118Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
15119 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
15120 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
15121 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
15122 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
15123
15124
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200151258.2.1. Default log format
15126-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015127
15128This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
15129as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
15130format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
15131
15132 Example :
15133 listen www
15134 mode http
15135 log global
15136 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15137
15138 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
15139 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
15140 (www/HTTP)
15141
15142 Field Format Extract from the example above
15143 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
15144 2 'Connect from' Connect from
15145 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
15146 4 'to' to
15147 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
15148 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
15149
15150Detailed fields description :
15151 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
15152 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
15153 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
15154 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
15155 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15156 and processed the connection.
15157 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
15158
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015159In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
15160"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
15161connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
15162
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015163It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
15164will eventually disappear.
15165
15166
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200151678.2.2. TCP log format
15168---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015169
15170The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
15171is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
15172information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
15173counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
15174emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
15175environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
15176the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
15177sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015178specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
15179not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
15180fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
15181marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015182
15183 Example :
15184 frontend fnt
15185 mode tcp
15186 option tcplog
15187 log global
15188 default_backend bck
15189
15190 backend bck
15191 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15192
15193 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
15194 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
15195 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
15196
15197 Field Format Extract from the example above
15198 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
15199 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
15200 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
15201 4 frontend_name fnt
15202 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
15203 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
15204 7 bytes_read* 212
15205 8 termination_state --
15206 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
15207 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
15208
15209Detailed fields description :
15210 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015211 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
15212 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
15213 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015214 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
15215 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
15216 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015217
15218 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015219 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
15220 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
15221 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015222
15223 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
15224 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
15225 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
15226 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
15227
15228 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15229 and processed the connection.
15230
15231 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
15232 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
15233 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
15234 applications.
15235
15236 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
15237 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
15238 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
15239 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
15240 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
15241
15242 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
15243 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
15244 See "Timers" below for more details.
15245
15246 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
15247 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
15248 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
15249 "Timers" below for more details.
15250
15251 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015252 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015253 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
15254 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
15255 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
15256 details.
15257
15258 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
15259 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
15260 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
15261 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
15262 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
15263
15264 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
15265 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
15266 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
15267 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
15268 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
15269 for more details.
15270
15271 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015272 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015273 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
15274 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
15275 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015276 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015277
15278 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
15279 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
15280 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
15281 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
15282 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
15283 caused by a denial of service attack.
15284
15285 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
15286 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
15287 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
15288 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
15289 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
15290 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
15291 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
15292 denial of service attack.
15293
15294 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
15295 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
15296 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
15297 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
15298 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
15299 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
15300 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
15301 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
15302 be processed than on other servers.
15303
15304 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
15305 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
15306 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
15307 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
15308 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
15309 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
15310 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
15311 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
15312 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
15313 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
15314 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
15315 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
15316 should not be attributed to the logged server.
15317
15318 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15319 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
15320 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
15321 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
15322 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
15323 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
15324 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
15325 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
15326
15327 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15328 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
15329 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
15330 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
15331 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
15332 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
15333 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
15334 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
15335 occurs.
15336
15337
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200153388.2.3. HTTP log format
15339----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015340
15341The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
15342is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
15343the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
15344are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
15345emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
15346generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
15347"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
15348which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015349frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
15350is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015351
15352Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
15353slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
15354with a star ('*') after the field name below.
15355
15356 Example :
15357 frontend http-in
15358 mode http
15359 option httplog
15360 log global
15361 default_backend bck
15362
15363 backend static
15364 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15365
15366 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
15367 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
15368 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015369 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015370
15371 Field Format Extract from the example above
15372 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
15373 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015374 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015375 4 frontend_name http-in
15376 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015377 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015378 7 status_code 200
15379 8 bytes_read* 2750
15380 9 captured_request_cookie -
15381 10 captured_response_cookie -
15382 11 termination_state ----
15383 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
15384 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
15385 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
15386 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
15387 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015388
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015389Detailed fields description :
15390 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015391 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
15392 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
15393 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015394 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
15395 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
15396 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015397
15398 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015399 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
15400 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
15401 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015402
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015403 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
15404 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015405
15406 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15407 and processed the connection.
15408
15409 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
15410 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
15411 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
15412
15413 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
15414 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
15415 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
15416 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
15417 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
15418 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
15419
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015420 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
15421 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
15422 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
15423 request could be received or the a bad request was received. It should
15424 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
15425 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
15426 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015427
15428 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
15429 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
15430 See "Timers" below for more details.
15431
15432 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
15433 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
15434 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
15435 below for more details.
15436
15437 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
15438 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
15439 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
15440 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
15441 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
15442 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
15443 for more details.
15444
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015445 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
15446 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
15447 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
15448 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
15449 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
15450 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
15451 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
15452 See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015453
15454 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
15455 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
15456 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
15457
15458 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
15459 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
15460 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
15461 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
15462 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
15463 overflowing.
15464
15465 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
15466 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
15467 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
15468 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
15469 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
15470 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
15471 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
15472 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
15473
15474 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
15475 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
15476 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
15477 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
15478 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
15479 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
15480 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
15481 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
15482
15483 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
15484 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
15485 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
15486 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
15487 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
15488 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
15489 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
15490
15491 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015492 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015493 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
15494 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
15495 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015496 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015497 system.
15498
15499 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
15500 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
15501 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
15502 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
15503 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
15504 caused by a denial of service attack.
15505
15506 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
15507 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
15508 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
15509 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
15510 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
15511 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
15512 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
15513 denial of service attack.
15514
15515 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
15516 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
15517 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
15518 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
15519 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
15520 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
15521 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
15522 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
15523 processed than on other servers.
15524
15525 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
15526 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
15527 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
15528 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
15529 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
15530 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
15531 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
15532 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
15533 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
15534 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
15535 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
15536 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
15537 should not be attributed to the logged server.
15538
15539 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15540 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
15541 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
15542 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
15543 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
15544 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
15545 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
15546 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
15547
15548 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15549 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
15550 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
15551 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
15552 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
15553 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
15554 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
15555 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
15556 occurs.
15557
15558 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
15559 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
15560 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
15561 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
15562 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
15563 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
15564 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
15565 cookies" below for more details.
15566
15567 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
15568 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
15569 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
15570 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
15571 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
15572 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
15573 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
15574 and cookies" below for more details.
15575
15576 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
15577 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
15578 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
15579 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
15580 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
15581 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
15582 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
15583 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
15584
15585
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200155868.2.4. Custom log format
15587------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015588
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015589The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015590mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015591
15592HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
15593Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
15594separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
15595prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
15596
15597Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
15598variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015599("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015600
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010015601If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020015602as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010015603less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
15604the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
15605
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015606Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015607In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010015608in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015609
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015610Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
15611'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
15612https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
15613such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
15614
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015615Flags are :
15616 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015617 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015618 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
15619 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015620
15621 Example:
15622
15623 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
15624 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
15625
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015626 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
15627
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015628At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
15629
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015630 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
15631 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015632
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015633the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015634
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015635 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
15636 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
15637 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015638
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015639and the default TCP format is defined this way :
15640
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015641 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
15642 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015643
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015644Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
15645
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015646 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015647 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015648 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
15649 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
15650 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015651 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
15652 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
15653 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015654 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000015655 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
15656 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000015657 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000015658 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
15659 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010015660 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020015661 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015662 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015663 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015664 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020015665 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080015666 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015667 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
15668 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
15669 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
15670 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
15671 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015672 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015673 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
15674 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015675 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015676 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
15677 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015678 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
15679 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
15680 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015681 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015682 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
15683 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015684 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015685 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
15686 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
15687 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020015688 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020015689 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020015690 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
15691 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
15692 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
15693 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020015694 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015695 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015696 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015697 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010015698 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015699 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015700 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
15701 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
15702 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015703 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015704 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
15705 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015706 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015707 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
15708 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
15709 | H | %trl | locla_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015710 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015711 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015712 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015713
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015714 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015715
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010015716
157178.2.5. Error log format
15718-----------------------
15719
15720When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
15721protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
15722By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
15723"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
15724will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
15725logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
15726
15727The format looks like this :
15728
15729 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
15730 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
15731 Connection error during SSL handshake
15732
15733 Field Format Extract from the example above
15734 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
15735 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
15736 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
15737 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
15738 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
15739
15740These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
15741failures.
15742
15743
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157448.3. Advanced logging options
15745-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015746
15747Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
15748just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
15749options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
15750for more information about their usage.
15751
15752
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157538.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
15754------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015755
15756It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
15757haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
15758commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
15759monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
15760ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
15761
15762 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
15763 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
15764 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
15765 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
15766
15767 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
15768 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
15769 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015770 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015771 such as other load-balancers.
15772
15773 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
15774 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
15775 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
15776
15777
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157788.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
15779----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015780
15781The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
15782what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
15783or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
15784"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
15785just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
15786log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
15787after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
15788is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
15789with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
15790with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
15791
15792
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157938.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
15794------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015795
15796Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
15797for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
15798"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
15799retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
15800raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
15801a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
15802file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
15803you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
15804"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
15805
15806
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158078.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
15808--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015809
15810Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
15811multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
15812them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
15813"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
15814logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
15815error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
15816and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
15817too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
15818useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
15819alternative.
15820
15821
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158228.4. Timing events
15823------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015824
15825Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
15826reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
15827the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
15828frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015829mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
15830addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
15831
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010015832Timings events in HTTP mode:
15833
15834 first request 2nd request
15835 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
15836 t tr t tr ...
15837 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
15838 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
15839 :<---- Tq ---->: :
15840 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
15841 :<--------- Ta --------->:
15842
15843Timings events in TCP mode:
15844
15845 TCP session
15846 |<----------------->|
15847 t t
15848 ---|----|----|----|----|---
15849 | Th Tw Tc Td |
15850 |<------ Tt ------->|
15851
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015852 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
15853 protocols. Currently, these protocoles are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
15854 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
15855 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
15856 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
15857 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (eg: MTU issues), or that an
15858 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015859
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015860 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
15861 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
15862 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
15863 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. Some
15864 browsers pre-establish connections to a server in order to reduce the
15865 latency of a future request, and keep them pending until they need it. This
15866 delay will be reported as the idle time. A value of -1 indicates that
15867 nothing was received on the connection.
15868
15869 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
15870 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
15871 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
15872 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
15873 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
15874 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
15875 request typed by hand during a test.
15876
15877 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
15878 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
15879 exactly equalt to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
15880 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
15881 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
15882 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
15883 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015884
15885 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
15886 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
15887 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
15888 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
15889 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
15890
15891 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
15892 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
15893 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
15894 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
15895 connection never established.
15896
15897 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
15898 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
15899 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
15900 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
15901 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
15902 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
15903 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
15904 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
15905 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
15906 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
15907 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
15908
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015909 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
15910 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
15911 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
15912 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
15913 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
15914 by subtracting other timers when valid :
15915
15916 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
15917
15918 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
15919 "Ta" can never be negative.
15920
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015921 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
15922 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015923 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
15924 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015925 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015926
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015927 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015928
15929 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015930 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
15931 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015932
15933These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
15934protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
15935that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015936due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
15937"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
15938that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015939
15940Most common cases :
15941
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015942 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
15943 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
15944 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
15945 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
15946 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
15947 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
15948 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
15949 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
15950 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
15951 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
15952 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020015953 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015954
15955 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
15956 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
15957 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
15958 of ms on remote networks.
15959
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015960 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
15961 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
15962 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015963
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015964 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
15965 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
15966 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
15967 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
15968 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
15969 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
15970 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
15971 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
15972 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015973
15974Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
15975
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015976 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015977 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015978 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015979
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015980 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015981 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
15982 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
15983
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015984 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015985 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
15986 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
15987 flags.
15988
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015989 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
15990 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015991 Check the session termination flags, then check the
15992 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
15993 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
15994 the client connection was maintained open.
15995
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015996 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015997 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015998 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015999 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
16000
16001
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200160028.5. Session state at disconnection
16003-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016004
16005TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
16006"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
160072-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
16008each of which has a special meaning :
16009
16010 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
16011 session to terminate :
16012
16013 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
16014
16015 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
16016 server explicitly refused it.
16017
16018 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
16019 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
16020 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
16021 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020016022 (eg: cacheable cookie).
16023
16024 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
16025 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016026
16027 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
16028 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
16029 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
16030 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
16031 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
16032
16033 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
16034 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
16035 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
16036 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
16037 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
16038
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090016039 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
16040 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
16041
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070016042 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
16043 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
16044 backup connections when going up.
16045
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020016046 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
16047
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016048 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
16049 send or receive data.
16050
16051 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
16052 send or receive data.
16053
16054 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
16055 with nothing left in the buffers.
16056
16057 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
16058
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010016059 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016060 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
16061
16062 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
16063 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
16064 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
16065 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
16066 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
16067
16068 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
16069 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
16070
16071 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
16072 server (HTTP only).
16073
16074 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
16075
16076 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
16077 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
16078 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
16079
16080 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
16081 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
16082 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
16083
16084 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
16085
16086 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
16087 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
16088
16089 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
16090 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
16091 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
16092
16093 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
16094 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020016095 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
16096 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016097
16098 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
16099 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
16100 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
16101 another server.
16102
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016103 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016104 server.
16105
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016106 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
16107 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
16108 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
16109 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
16110
16111 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
16112 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
16113 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
16114 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
16115
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020016116 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
16117 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
16118 "use-server" rule).
16119
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016120 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
16121
16122 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
16123 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
16124
16125 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
16126
16127 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
16128 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
16129 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
16130
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016131 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
16132 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016133 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016134 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
16135 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
16136
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016137 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
16138
16139 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
16140 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
16141
16142 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
16143
16144 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
16145
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016146The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
16147was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016148helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
16149starvation, attacks, etc...
16150
16151The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
16152alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
16153easier finding and understanding.
16154
16155 Flags Reason
16156
16157 -- Normal termination.
16158
16159 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
16160 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
16161 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
16162 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
16163
16164 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
16165 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
16166 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
16167 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
16168 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
16169 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016170
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016171 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
16172 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020016173 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016174
16175 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
16176 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
16177 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
16178
16179 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
16180 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
16181 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
16182 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
16183 the server takes too long to respond.
16184
16185 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
16186 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
16187 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
16188 long a time to respond.
16189
16190 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
16191 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
16192 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
16193 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020016194 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
16195 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016196
16197 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
16198 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
16199 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
16200 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
16201 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020016202 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020016203 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
16204 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
16205 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
16206 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
16207 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
16208 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
16209 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
16210 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
16211 around the undesirable effects of this behaviour by adding "option
16212 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
16213 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
16214 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016215
16216 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
16217 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016218 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
16219 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
16220 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
16221 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016222
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020016223 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
16224 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
16225
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016226 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016227 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
16228 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
16229 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
16230 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
16231 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
16232
16233 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
16234 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
16235 503 or 504 here.
16236
16237 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
16238 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
16239 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
16240 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
16241 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
16242
16243 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
16244 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016245 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016246 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
16247 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
16248
16249 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
16250 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
16251 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
16252 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
16253 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
16254 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
16255 between haproxy and the server.
16256
16257 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
16258 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
16259 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
16260 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
16261 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
16262 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
16263 solution is to fix the application.
16264
16265 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
16266 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
16267 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
16268 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
16269 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
16270 external attacks.
16271
16272 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
16273 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020016274 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016275 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
16276 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
16277
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016278 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
16279 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
16280 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020016281 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
16282 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016283
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016284 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
16285 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
16286 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
16287 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016288 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
16289 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
16290 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
16291 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
16292 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016293
16294 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
16295 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
16296 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
16297 returned an HTTP 403 error.
16298
16299 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
16300 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
16301 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
16302 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
16303
16304 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
16305 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
16306 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
16307 only be solved by proper system tuning.
16308
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016309The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
16310persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
16311important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
16312re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
16313
16314 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
16315
16316 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
16317 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
16318 set on a GET request.
16319
16320 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
16321 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016322 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016323 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
16324
16325 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
16326 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
16327 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
16328
16329 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
16330 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
16331 already got a cookie.
16332
16333 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
16334 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
16335 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
16336 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
16337 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
16338
16339 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
16340 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
16341 new cookie was inserted in the response.
16342
16343 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
16344 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
16345 new cookie was inserted in the response.
16346
16347 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
16348 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
16349
16350 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
16351 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
16352 then advertised in the response.
16353
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016354
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163558.6. Non-printable characters
16356-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016357
16358In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
16359consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
16360converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
16361prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
16362being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
16363escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
16364is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
16365'}' when logging headers.
16366
16367Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
16368issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
16369containing spaces is "User-Agent".
16370
16371Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
16372the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
16373performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
16374
16375
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163768.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
16377---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016378
16379Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
16380achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016381section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016382cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
16383the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
16384the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016385locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016386not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
16387user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
16388a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
16389wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
16390
16391 Examples :
16392 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
16393 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
16394
16395 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
16396 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
16397
16398
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163998.8. Capturing HTTP headers
16400---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016401
16402Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
16403proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
16404the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
16405server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
16406
16407Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
16408response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016409section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016410
16411It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016412time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
16413appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016414are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
16415and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
16416follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
16417request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
16418in the logs.
16419
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020016420As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
16421frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
16422an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
16423
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016424 Example :
16425 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
16426 listen proxy-out
16427 mode http
16428 option httplog
16429 option logasap
16430 log global
16431 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
16432
16433 # log the name of the virtual server
16434 capture request header Host len 20
16435
16436 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
16437 capture request header Content-Length len 10
16438
16439 # log the beginning of the referrer
16440 capture request header Referer len 20
16441
16442 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
16443 capture response header Server len 20
16444
16445 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
16446 capture response header Content-Length len 10
16447
16448 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
16449 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
16450
16451 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
16452 capture response header Via len 20
16453
16454 # log the URL location during a redirection
16455 capture response header Location len 20
16456
16457 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
16458 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
16459 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16460 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
16461 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
16462
16463 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
16464 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
16465 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16466 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016467 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016468
16469 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
16470 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
16471 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16472 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
16473 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016474 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016475
16476
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164778.9. Examples of logs
16478---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016479
16480These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
16481them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
16482reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
16483
16484 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
16485 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
16486 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
16487
16488 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
16489 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
16490
16491 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
16492 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
16493 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
16494
16495 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
16496 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
16497
16498 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
16499 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
16500 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
16501
16502 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016503 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016504 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
16505 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
16506
16507 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
16508 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
16509 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
16510
16511 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
16512 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020016513 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016514 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
16515 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
16516 to return the 502 and not the server.
16517
16518 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016519 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016520
16521 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
16522 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
16523 Nothing was sent to any server.
16524
16525 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
16526 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
16527
16528 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
16529 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
16530 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
16531 send a 408 return code to the client.
16532
16533 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
16534 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
16535
16536 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
16537 5 seconds ("c----").
16538
16539 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
16540 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016541 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016542
16543 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016544 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016545 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
16546 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
16547 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
16548 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
16549 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016550
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020016551
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200165529. Supported filters
16553--------------------
16554
16555Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
16556accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
16557unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
16558
16559See also : "filter"
16560
165619.1. Trace
16562----------
16563
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010016564filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020016565
16566 Arguments:
16567 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
16568 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
16569
16570 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
16571 the client and the server. By default, this filter
16572 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
16573 only parses a random amount of the available data.
16574
16575 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwading of parsed data. By
16576 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
16577 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
16578 amount of the parsed data.
16579
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010016580 <hexump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
16581
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020016582This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
16583callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
16584information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
16585filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
16586
16587Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
16588tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
16589a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
16590
16591
165929.2. HTTP compression
16593---------------------
16594
16595filter compression
16596
16597The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
16598keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
16599when no other filter is used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly
16600use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when two or more filters are
16601used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the
16602filters evaluation order.
16603
16604See also : "compression"
16605
16606
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200166079.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
16608--------------------------------------------
16609
16610filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
16611
16612 Arguments :
16613
16614 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
16615 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
16616 parsed.
16617
16618 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
16619 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
16620 part must be placed in its own scope.
16621
16622The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
16623external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
16624streams in tierce applications. These external components and information
16625exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
16626also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
16627
16628SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
16629the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
16630
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016631For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020016632"doc/SPOE.txt".
16633
16634Important note:
16635 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
16636 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
16637
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016638/*
16639 * Local variables:
16640 * fill-column: 79
16641 * End:
16642 */